3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle GNU Coreutils
5 @documentencoding UTF-8
11 @include constants.texi
13 @c Define new indices.
17 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
27 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
28 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options.
29 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
30 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
33 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
34 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
35 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
37 @dircategory Individual utilities
39 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
40 * base32: (coreutils)base32 invocation. Base32 encode/decode data.
41 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
42 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
43 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
44 * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. Change SELinux CTX of files.
45 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
46 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change access permissions.
47 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners and groups.
48 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
49 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
50 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
51 * coreutils: (coreutils)Multi-call invocation. Multi-call program.
52 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
53 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
54 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
55 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
56 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
57 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
58 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
59 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
60 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip last file name component.
61 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
62 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
63 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
64 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
65 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
66 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
67 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
68 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
69 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
70 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
71 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
72 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
73 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
74 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
75 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy files and set attributes.
76 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
77 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
78 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
79 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
80 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
81 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
82 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
83 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
84 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
85 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
86 * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. Create temporary files.
87 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
88 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
89 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
90 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
91 * nproc: (coreutils)nproc invocation. Print the number of processors.
92 * numfmt: (coreutils)numfmt invocation. Reformat numbers.
93 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
94 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
95 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
96 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
97 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
98 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
99 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
100 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
101 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
102 * realpath: (coreutils)realpath invocation. Print resolved file names.
103 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
104 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
105 * runcon: (coreutils)runcon invocation. Run in specified SELinux CTX.
106 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
107 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
108 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
109 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
110 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
111 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
112 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
113 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into pieces.
114 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
115 * stdbuf: (coreutils)stdbuf invocation. Modify stdio buffering.
116 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
117 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
118 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory to disk.
119 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
120 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
121 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
122 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
123 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
124 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
125 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
126 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
127 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
128 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
129 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
130 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
131 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
132 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
133 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
134 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
135 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
136 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
137 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
138 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
139 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
140 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
144 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the GNU core
145 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
147 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
150 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
151 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
152 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
153 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
154 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
155 Free Documentation License''.
160 @title GNU @code{Coreutils}
161 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
162 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
163 @author David MacKenzie et al.
166 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
179 @cindex core utilities
180 @cindex text utilities
181 @cindex shell utilities
182 @cindex file utilities
185 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors
186 * Common options:: Common options
187 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od base32 base64
188 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
189 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
190 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
191 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
192 * Operating on fields:: cut paste join
193 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
194 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
195 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
196 * Special file types:: mkdir rmdir unlink mkfifo mknod ln link readlink
197 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
198 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync truncate
199 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
200 * Conditions:: false true test expr
202 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk mktemp realpath
203 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
204 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
205 * System context:: date arch nproc uname hostname hostid uptime
206 * SELinux context:: chcon runcon
207 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup stdbuf timeout
208 * Process control:: kill
210 * Numeric operations:: factor numfmt seq
211 * File permissions:: Access modes
212 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
213 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy
214 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
215 * Concept index:: General index
218 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
222 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure
223 * Backup options:: Backup options
224 * Block size:: Block size
225 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation
226 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
227 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
228 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
229 * Target directory:: Target directory
230 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
231 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
232 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
233 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
234 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation
236 Output of entire files
238 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files
239 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse
240 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files
241 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats
242 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
243 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
245 Formatting file contents
247 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text
248 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing
249 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
251 Output of parts of files
253 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files
254 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files
255 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
256 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces
260 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts
261 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts
262 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
263 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests
264 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests
265 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests
267 Operating on sorted files
269 * sort invocation:: Sort text files
270 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files
271 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files
272 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line
273 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents
274 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort
276 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
278 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior
279 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations
280 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection
281 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields
282 * Compatibility in ptx:: The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
286 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines
287 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files
288 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field
290 Operating on characters
292 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
293 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces
294 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs
296 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
298 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters
299 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another
300 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting
304 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
305 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
306 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
307 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
309 @command{ls}: List directory contents
311 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
312 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
313 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
314 * Details about version sort:: More details about version sort
315 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
316 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
320 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
321 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
322 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
323 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
324 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
325 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
329 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
330 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
331 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
332 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
333 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
334 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
335 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
336 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
338 Changing file attributes
340 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
341 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
342 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
343 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
347 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
348 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
349 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
350 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
351 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
355 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
356 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
357 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
361 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
362 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
363 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
364 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
366 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
368 * File type tests:: File type tests
369 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
370 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
371 * String tests:: String tests
372 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
374 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
376 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
377 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
378 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
379 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
383 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
385 File name manipulation
387 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
388 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component
389 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability
390 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory
391 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names
395 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
396 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
397 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
398 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
400 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
402 * Control:: Control settings
403 * Input:: Input settings
404 * Output:: Output settings
405 * Local:: Local settings
406 * Combination:: Combination settings
407 * Characters:: Special characters
408 * Special:: Special settings
412 * id invocation:: Print user identity
413 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
414 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
415 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
416 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
417 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
421 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
422 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
423 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors
424 * uname invocation:: Print system information
425 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
426 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
427 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
429 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
431 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
432 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
433 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
434 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
435 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock
436 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time
437 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
438 * Examples of date:: Examples
442 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
443 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
445 Modified command invocation
447 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
448 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
449 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
450 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
451 * stdbuf invocation:: Run a command with modified I/O buffering
452 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
456 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
460 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
464 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
465 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers
466 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
470 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits
471 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits
472 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers
473 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories
477 * General date syntax:: Common rules
478 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994
479 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm
480 * Time zone items:: EST, PDT, UTC, @dots{}
481 * Combined date and time of day items:: 1972-09-24T20:02:00,000000-0500
482 * Day of week items:: Monday and others
483 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago
484 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440
485 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502
486 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0"
487 * Authors of parse_datetime:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
489 Opening the software toolbox
491 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
492 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
493 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
494 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
495 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
496 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
497 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
501 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
508 @chapter Introduction
510 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
511 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
512 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire GNU community
516 The GNU utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
518 @cindex bugs, reporting
519 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
520 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
521 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
522 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
523 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
524 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
530 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
533 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
534 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
535 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
536 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
537 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
538 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
539 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
540 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
541 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
542 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
543 insights to the overall process.
546 @chapter Common options
550 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
553 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
554 @cindex backups, making
555 @xref{Backup options}.
556 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
559 @macro optBackupSuffix
560 @item -S @var{suffix}
561 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
564 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
565 @xref{Backup options}.
568 @macro optTargetDirectory
569 @item -t @var{directory}
570 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
572 @opindex --target-directory
573 @cindex target directory
574 @cindex destination directory
575 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
576 @xref{Target directory}.
579 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
581 @itemx --no-target-directory
583 @opindex --no-target-directory
584 @cindex target directory
585 @cindex destination directory
586 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
587 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
591 @cindex output NUL-byte-terminated lines
592 Output a zero byte (ASCII NUL) at the end of each line,
593 rather than a newline. This option enables other programs to parse the
594 output even when that output would contain data with embedded newlines.
613 @macro optZeroTerminated
615 @itemx --zero-terminated
617 @opindex --zero-terminated
618 @cindex process zero-terminated items
619 Delimit items with a zero byte rather than a newline (ASCII LF).
620 I.e., treat input as items separated by ASCII NUL
621 and terminate output items with ASCII NUL.
622 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
623 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
624 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
625 or other special characters).
632 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
633 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
634 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
635 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
636 @option{--human-readable} option if
637 you prefer powers of 1024.
640 @macro optHumanReadable
642 @itemx --human-readable
644 @opindex --human-readable
645 @cindex human-readable output
646 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
647 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
648 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
649 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
652 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
653 @item --strip-trailing-slashes
654 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
655 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
656 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
657 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
660 @macro mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{cmd}
661 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
662 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
663 Due to shell aliases and built-in @command{\cmd\} functions, using an
664 unadorned @command{\cmd\} interactively or in a script may get you
665 different functionality than that described here. Invoke it via
666 @command{env} (i.e., @code{env \cmd\ @dots{}}) to avoid interference
671 @macro multiplierSuffixes{varName}
672 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
673 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
675 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
676 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
677 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
678 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
679 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
680 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
681 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
683 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
686 @c FIXME: same as above, but no ``blocks'' line.
687 @macro multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{varName}
688 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
689 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
691 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
692 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
693 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
694 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
695 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
696 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
698 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
701 @cindex common options
703 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
704 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
705 described here. (In fact, every GNU program accepts (or should accept)
708 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
709 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
710 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
711 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
712 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
713 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
714 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
716 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
717 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
718 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
719 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
720 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
721 specify a command that itself contains options.
723 Most programs that accept long options recognize unambiguous
724 abbreviations of those options. For example, @samp{rmdir
725 --ignore-fail-on-non-empty} can be invoked as @samp{rmdir
726 --ignore-fail} or even @samp{rmdir --i}. Ambiguous options, such as
727 @samp{ls --h}, are identified as such.
729 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
730 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument. For
731 these programs, abbreviations of the long options are not always recognized.
738 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
742 @cindex version number, finding
743 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
747 @cindex option delimiter
748 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
749 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
750 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
754 @cindex standard input
755 @cindex standard output
756 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
757 stands for a file operand, and some tools treat it as standard input, or as
758 standard output if that is clear from the context. For example, @samp{sort -}
759 reads from standard input, and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}. Unless
760 otherwise specified, a @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
764 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
765 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
766 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
767 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation.
768 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals using the --signal option.
769 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
770 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
771 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
772 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
773 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
774 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
775 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @dots{}
776 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the POSIX standard.
777 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation.
785 An exit status of zero indicates success,
786 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
789 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
790 that can be used to change how other commands work.
791 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
792 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
793 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as POSIX
794 requires only that it be nonzero.
796 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
797 other exit status values and a few associate different
798 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
799 Here are some of the exceptions:
800 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr}, @command{nice},
801 @command{nohup}, @command{numfmt}, @command{printenv}, @command{sort},
802 @command{stdbuf}, @command{test}, @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
806 @section Backup options
808 @cindex backup options
810 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
811 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
812 before writing new versions.
813 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
814 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
819 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
822 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
823 @cindex backups, making
824 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
825 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
826 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
827 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
828 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
829 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
830 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
832 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
833 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
835 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
836 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
837 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
838 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
839 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
844 @opindex none @r{backup method}
849 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
850 Always make numbered backups.
854 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
855 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
860 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
861 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
862 confused with @samp{none}.
866 @item -S @var{suffix}
867 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
870 @cindex backup suffix
871 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
872 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
873 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
874 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
875 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
884 Some GNU programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
885 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
886 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
887 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
888 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
890 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
893 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
894 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
895 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
896 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
898 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
899 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
904 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
905 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
906 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
909 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
910 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
913 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
914 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
915 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
916 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
917 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
920 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
921 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
922 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
927 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
928 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
929 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
932 @cindex human-readable output
935 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
936 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
937 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
938 that are upward compatible with the
939 @uref{http://www.bipm.org/en/publications/si-brochure/chapter3.html,
941 for decimal multiples and with the
942 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, ISO/IEC 80000-13
943 (formerly IEC 60027-2) prefixes} for binary multiples.
945 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
946 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
947 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
948 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
949 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
952 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
953 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
954 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
955 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
956 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
957 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
960 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
961 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
962 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
963 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
964 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
965 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
966 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
968 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
969 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
970 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
973 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
974 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
978 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
979 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
983 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
984 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
985 @samp{k} and the ISO/IEC 80000-13 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
986 POSIX use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
988 @cindex megabyte, definition of
989 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
992 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
993 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
995 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
996 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
999 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
1000 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
1002 @cindex terabyte, definition of
1003 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
1006 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
1007 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
1009 @cindex petabyte, definition of
1010 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
1013 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
1014 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
1016 @cindex exabyte, definition of
1017 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1020 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
1021 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
1023 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
1024 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
1027 @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
1029 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
1030 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1033 @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
1038 @opindex --block-size
1039 @opindex --human-readable
1042 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
1043 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
1044 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
1045 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
1046 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
1047 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
1048 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}. Note for @command{ls}
1049 the @option{-k} option does not control the display of the
1050 apparent file sizes, whereas the @option{--block-size} option does.
1052 @node Floating point
1053 @section Floating point numbers
1054 @cindex floating point
1055 @cindex IEEE floating point
1057 Commands that accept or produce floating point numbers employ the
1058 floating point representation of the underlying system, and suffer
1059 from rounding error, overflow, and similar floating-point issues.
1060 Almost all modern systems use IEEE-754 floating point, and it is
1061 typically portable to assume IEEE-754 behavior these days. IEEE-754
1062 has positive and negative infinity, distinguishes positive from
1063 negative zero, and uses special values called NaNs to represent
1064 invalid computations such as dividing zero by itself. For more
1065 information, please see David Goldberg's paper
1066 @uref{http://@/www.validlab.com/@/goldberg/@/paper.pdf, What Every
1067 Computer Scientist Should Know About Floating-Point Arithmetic}.
1070 Commands that accept floating point numbers as options, operands or
1071 input use the standard C functions @code{strtod} and @code{strtold} to
1072 convert from text to floating point numbers. These floating point
1073 numbers therefore can use scientific notation like @code{1.0e-34} and
1074 @code{-10e100}. Commands that parse floating point also understand
1075 case-insensitive @code{inf}, @code{infinity}, and @code{NaN}, although
1076 whether such values are useful depends on the command in question.
1077 Modern C implementations also accept hexadecimal floating point
1078 numbers such as @code{-0x.ep-3}, which stands for @minus{}14/16 times
1079 @math{2^-3}, which equals @minus{}0.109375. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
1080 locale determines the decimal-point character. @xref{Parsing of
1081 Floats,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
1083 @node Signal specifications
1084 @section Signal specifications
1085 @cindex signals, specifying
1087 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
1088 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
1089 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
1090 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
1091 and numbers are supported on all POSIX compliant systems:
1097 2. Terminal interrupt.
1103 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
1111 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
1112 numbers. All systems conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001 also
1113 support the following signals:
1117 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
1119 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
1121 Continue executing, if stopped.
1123 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
1125 Illegal Instruction.
1127 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
1129 Invalid memory reference.
1131 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
1135 Background process attempting read.
1137 Background process attempting write.
1139 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
1141 User-defined signal 1.
1143 User-defined signal 2.
1147 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XSI extension
1148 also support the following signals:
1154 Profiling timer expired.
1158 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1160 Virtual timer expired.
1162 CPU time limit exceeded.
1164 File size limit exceeded.
1168 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XRT extension
1169 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1170 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1172 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1173 @section chown, chgrp, chroot, id: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1174 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1175 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1176 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1177 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1178 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1180 Since the @var{user} and @var{group} arguments to these commands
1181 may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1183 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1184 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
1185 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID@?
1186 POSIX requires that these commands
1187 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1188 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID@.
1189 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1190 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1191 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1192 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1193 1000---not what you intended.
1195 GNU @command{chown}, @command{chgrp}, @command{chroot}, and @command{id}
1196 provide a way to work around this, that at the same time may result in a
1197 significant performance improvement by eliminating a database look-up.
1198 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1199 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1203 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1207 The name look-up process is skipped for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1208 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1209 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1211 @node Random sources
1212 @section Sources of random data
1214 @cindex random sources
1216 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1217 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1218 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1219 make this selection.
1221 By default these commands use an internal pseudo-random generator
1222 initialized by a small amount of entropy, but can be directed to use
1223 an external source with the @option{--random-source=@var{file}} option.
1224 An error is reported if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes.
1226 For example, the device file @file{/dev/urandom} could be used as the
1227 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1228 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1229 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1230 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1231 cryptographically secure pseudo-random number generator. But be aware
1232 that this device is not designed for bulk random data generation
1233 and is relatively slow.
1235 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1236 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1237 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1238 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1241 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1242 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1243 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1245 Rather than depending on a file, one can generate a reproducible
1246 arbitrary amount of pseudo-random data given a seed value, using
1253 openssl enc -aes-256-ctr -pass pass:"$seed" -nosalt \
1254 </dev/zero 2>/dev/null
1257 shuf -i1-100 --random-source=<(get_seeded_random 42)
1260 @node Target directory
1261 @section Target directory
1263 @cindex target directory
1265 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1266 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1267 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1268 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1269 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1270 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1271 allow more fine-grained control:
1276 @itemx --no-target-directory
1277 @opindex --no-target-directory
1278 @cindex target directory
1279 @cindex destination directory
1280 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1281 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1282 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1283 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1284 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1285 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1286 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1287 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1288 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1290 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1291 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1292 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1294 @item -t @var{directory}
1295 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
1296 @opindex --target-directory
1297 @cindex target directory
1298 @cindex destination directory
1299 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1302 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1303 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1304 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1305 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1306 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1308 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1309 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1310 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1311 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1312 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1313 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1314 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1315 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1318 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1319 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1320 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1321 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1324 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1327 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1328 If you use the GNU @command{find} program, you can move those
1329 files too, with this command:
1332 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1336 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1337 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1338 some other special characters.
1339 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1340 GNU @command{find} and GNU @command{xargs}:
1343 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1344 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1351 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1352 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1353 options cannot be combined.
1355 @node Trailing slashes
1356 @section Trailing slashes
1358 @cindex trailing slashes
1360 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1361 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1362 operating on it. The @option{--strip-trailing-slashes} option enables
1365 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1366 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1367 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1368 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1369 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1370 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1371 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1372 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1373 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1374 be the default, it is required by POSIX and is consistent with
1375 other parts of that standard.
1377 @node Traversing symlinks
1378 @section Traversing symlinks
1380 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1382 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1383 @c FIXME: note that 'du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1384 @c different meaning.
1385 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1386 option is also specified.
1387 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1389 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1390 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1391 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1393 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1394 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1395 a symlink or its referent.
1402 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse if on the command line
1403 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1404 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1411 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1412 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1413 that is encountered.
1420 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1421 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1422 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1423 or @option{-P} is specified.
1430 @node Treating / specially
1431 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1433 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1434 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1435 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1436 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1437 legitimate uses for such a command,
1438 GNU @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1439 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1440 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1441 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1442 @option{--preserve-root} option, is safer for most purposes.
1444 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1445 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1446 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1447 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1448 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1449 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1450 interrupt them. Tradition and POSIX require these commands
1451 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1452 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1453 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1454 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1456 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1457 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1458 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1460 @node Special built-in utilities
1461 @section Special built-in utilities
1463 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1464 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1465 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1466 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1467 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1468 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1471 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1472 by POSIX 1003.1-2004.
1475 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1476 return set shift times trap unset}
1479 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1480 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1481 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1483 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1484 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1485 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1486 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1488 @node Standards conformance
1489 @section Standards conformance
1491 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1492 In a few cases, the GNU utilities' default behavior is
1493 incompatible with the POSIX standard. To suppress these
1494 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1495 variable. Unless you are checking for POSIX conformance, you
1496 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1498 Newer versions of POSIX are occasionally incompatible with older
1499 versions. For example, older versions of POSIX required the
1500 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1501 fields in each input line, but starting with POSIX 1003.1-2001
1502 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1503 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1506 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1507 The GNU utilities normally conform to the version of POSIX
1508 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1509 different version of POSIX, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1510 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1511 the year and month the standard was adopted. Three values are currently
1512 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1513 POSIX 1003.2-1992, @samp{200112} stands for POSIX
1514 1003.1-2001, and @samp{200809} stands for POSIX 1003.1-2008.
1515 For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1516 that assumes an older version of POSIX and uses @samp{sort +1}
1517 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1518 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1520 @c This node is named "Multi-call invocation", not the usual
1521 @c "coreutils invocation", so that shell commands like
1522 @c 'info coreutils "touch invocation"' work as expected.
1523 @node Multi-call invocation
1524 @section @command{coreutils}: Multi-call program
1528 @cindex calling combined multi-call program
1530 The @command{coreutils} command invokes an individual utility, either
1531 implicitly selected by the last component of the name used to invoke
1532 @command{coreutils}, or explicitly with the
1533 @option{--coreutils-prog} option. Synopsis:
1536 coreutils @option{--coreutils-prog=PROGRAM} @dots{}
1539 The @command{coreutils} command is not installed by default, so
1540 portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
1542 @node Output of entire files
1543 @chapter Output of entire files
1545 @cindex output of entire files
1546 @cindex entire files, output of
1548 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1552 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1553 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1554 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1555 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1556 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1557 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1560 @node cat invocation
1561 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1564 @cindex concatenate and write files
1565 @cindex copying files
1567 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1568 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1571 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1574 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1582 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1585 @itemx --number-nonblank
1587 @opindex --number-nonblank
1588 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1592 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1597 @opindex --show-ends
1598 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1604 Number all output lines, starting with 1. This option is ignored
1605 if @option{-b} is in effect.
1608 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1610 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1611 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1612 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1617 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1622 @opindex --show-tabs
1623 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1627 Ignored; for POSIX compatibility.
1630 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1632 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1633 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1634 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1639 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1640 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1641 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1642 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1643 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1644 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1645 if standard output is a terminal.
1652 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1655 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1660 @node tac invocation
1661 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1664 @cindex reversing files
1666 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1667 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1668 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1671 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1674 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1675 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1676 the record that it follows in the file.
1678 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1686 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1687 precedes in the file.
1693 Treat the separator string as a regular expression.
1695 @item -s @var{separator}
1696 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1698 @opindex --separator
1699 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1703 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1704 @command{tac} reads and writes in binary mode.
1711 # Reverse a file character by character.
1717 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1720 @cindex numbering lines
1721 @cindex line numbering
1723 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1724 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1725 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1728 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1731 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1732 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1733 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1734 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1735 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1737 @cindex headers, numbering
1738 @cindex body, numbering
1739 @cindex footers, numbering
1740 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1741 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1742 style from the others.
1744 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1745 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1756 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1757 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1758 length of each string cannot be changed.
1760 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1761 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1762 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1763 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1765 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1769 @item -b @var{style}
1770 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1772 @opindex --body-numbering
1773 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1774 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1775 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1776 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1782 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1784 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1786 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1787 expression @var{bre}.
1788 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1792 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1794 @opindex --section-delimiter
1795 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1796 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1797 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1798 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1799 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1801 @item -f @var{style}
1802 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1804 @opindex --footer-numbering
1805 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1807 @item -h @var{style}
1808 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1810 @opindex --header-numbering
1811 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1813 @item -i @var{number}
1814 @itemx --line-increment=@var{number}
1816 @opindex --line-increment
1817 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1819 @item -l @var{number}
1820 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1822 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1823 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1824 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1825 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1826 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1827 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1828 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1831 @item -n @var{format}
1832 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1834 @opindex --number-format
1835 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1839 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1840 left justified, no leading zeros;
1842 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1843 right justified, no leading zeros;
1845 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1846 right justified, leading zeros.
1850 @itemx --no-renumber
1852 @opindex --no-renumber
1853 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1855 @item -s @var{string}
1856 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1858 @opindex --number-separator
1859 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1860 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1862 @item -v @var{number}
1863 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1865 @opindex --starting-line-number
1866 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1868 @item -w @var{number}
1869 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1871 @opindex --number-width
1872 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1880 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1883 @cindex octal dump of files
1884 @cindex hex dump of files
1885 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1886 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1888 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1889 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1893 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1894 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1895 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}]@c
1896 [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1899 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1900 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1901 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1902 printed as a single octal number.
1904 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1905 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1906 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1907 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1908 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1909 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1910 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1912 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1913 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1914 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1915 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1918 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1922 @item -A @var{radix}
1923 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1925 @opindex --address-radix
1926 @cindex radix for file offsets
1927 @cindex file offset radix
1928 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1929 be one of the following:
1939 none (do not print offsets).
1942 The default is octal.
1944 @item --endian=@var{order}
1946 @cindex byte-swapping
1948 Reorder input bytes, to handle inputs with differing byte orders,
1949 or to provide consistent output independent of the endian convention
1950 of the current system. Swapping is performed according to the
1951 specified @option{--type} size and endian @var{order}, which can be
1952 @samp{little} or @samp{big}.
1954 @item -j @var{bytes}
1955 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1957 @opindex --skip-bytes
1958 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1959 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1960 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1962 @multiplierSuffixes{bytes}
1964 @item -N @var{bytes}
1965 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1967 @opindex --read-bytes
1968 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1969 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1971 @item -S @var{bytes}
1972 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1975 @cindex string constants, outputting
1976 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1977 least @var{bytes} consecutive ASCII graphic characters,
1978 followed by a zero byte (ASCII NUL).
1979 Prefixes and suffixes on @var{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1982 If @var{bytes} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1985 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1988 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1989 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1990 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1991 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1992 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1993 in the order that you specified.
1995 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1996 of the single byte character representation of the printable characters
1997 to the output line generated by the type specification.
2001 named character, ignoring high-order bit
2003 printable single byte character, C backslash escape
2004 or a 3 digit octal sequence
2008 floating point (@pxref{Floating point})
2017 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
2018 newline, and @samp{nul} for a zero byte. Only the least significant
2019 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
2020 Type @code{c} outputs
2021 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
2024 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
2025 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
2026 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
2027 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
2028 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
2029 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
2030 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
2043 For floating point (@code{f}):
2055 @itemx --output-duplicates
2057 @opindex --output-duplicates
2058 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
2059 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
2060 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
2061 indicate the elision.
2064 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
2067 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
2068 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
2071 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
2072 omitted, the default is 32.
2076 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
2077 GNU @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
2078 specification options. These options accumulate.
2084 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
2088 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
2092 Output as printable single byte characters, C backslash escapes
2093 or 3 digit octal sequences. Equivalent to @samp{-t c}.
2097 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
2101 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
2105 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
2109 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
2113 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
2117 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
2121 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
2124 @opindex --traditional
2125 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
2126 accepted. The following syntax:
2129 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
2133 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
2134 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
2135 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
2136 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
2137 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
2145 @node base32 invocation
2146 @section @command{base32}: Transform data into printable data
2149 @cindex base32 encoding
2151 @command{base32} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2152 into (or from) base32 encoded form. The base32 encoded form uses
2153 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2154 The usage and options of this command are precisely the
2155 same as for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2158 @node base64 invocation
2159 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data
2162 @cindex base64 encoding
2164 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2165 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
2166 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2170 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2171 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2174 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
2175 The base32 encoding expands data to roughly 160% of the original.
2176 The format conforms to
2177 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc4648.txt, RFC 4648}.
2179 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2184 @itemx --wrap=@var{cols}
2188 @cindex column to wrap data after
2189 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{cols} characters. This must be
2192 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
2193 disable line wrapping altogether.
2199 @cindex Decode base64 data
2200 @cindex Base64 decoding
2201 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
2202 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
2203 output will be the original data.
2206 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2208 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2209 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2210 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2211 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2212 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2219 @node Formatting file contents
2220 @chapter Formatting file contents
2222 @cindex formatting file contents
2224 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2227 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2228 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2229 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2233 @node fmt invocation
2234 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2237 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2238 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2239 @cindex text, reformatting
2241 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2242 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2245 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2248 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2249 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2251 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2252 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2253 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2256 @cindex line-breaking
2257 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2258 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2259 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2260 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2261 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2262 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2263 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2264 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2265 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2266 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2267 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2268 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2271 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2276 @itemx --crown-margin
2278 @opindex --crown-margin
2279 @cindex crown margin
2280 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2281 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2282 line with that of the second line.
2285 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2287 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2288 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2289 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2290 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2291 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2297 @opindex --split-only
2298 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2299 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2300 being unduly combined.
2303 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2305 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2306 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2307 between sentences to two spaces.
2310 @itemx -w @var{width}
2311 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2312 @opindex -@var{width}
2315 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75 or @var{goal}
2316 plus 10, if @var{goal} is provided).
2319 @itemx --goal=@var{goal}
2322 @command{fmt} initially tries to make lines @var{goal} characters wide.
2323 By default, this is 7% shorter than @var{width}.
2325 @item -p @var{prefix}
2326 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2327 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2328 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2329 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2330 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2331 leaving the code unchanged.
2338 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2341 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2342 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2343 @cindex merging files in parallel
2345 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2346 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2347 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2348 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2351 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2355 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2356 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2357 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2358 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2359 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2360 The text line of the header takes the form
2361 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2362 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2363 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2364 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2365 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2366 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2367 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2370 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2371 feeds produce empty pages.
2373 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2374 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2375 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2377 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2378 truncate lines in that case.
2380 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2384 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2385 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2386 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain ':'
2387 @c The 'info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2388 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2389 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2390 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2391 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2392 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2393 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2394 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2395 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2396 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2397 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2398 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2402 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2403 @opindex -@var{column}
2405 @cindex down columns
2406 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2407 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2408 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2409 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2410 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2411 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2412 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2413 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2414 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2415 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2416 with @option{-m} option.
2422 @cindex across columns
2423 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2424 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2425 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2428 @itemx --show-control-chars
2430 @opindex --show-control-chars
2431 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2432 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2433 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2436 @itemx --double-space
2438 @opindex --double-space
2439 @cindex double spacing
2440 Double space the output.
2442 @item -D @var{format}
2443 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2444 @cindex time formats
2445 @cindex formatting times
2446 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2447 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}. @xref{date invocation}.
2448 Except for directives, which start with
2449 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2450 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2451 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2453 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2455 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2456 @samp{2001-12-04 23:59});
2457 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2458 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the POSIX
2459 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2460 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2463 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2464 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2465 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2466 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2468 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2469 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2471 @opindex --expand-tabs
2473 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2474 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2475 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2483 @opindex --form-feed
2484 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2485 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2487 @item -h @var{header}
2488 @itemx --header=@var{header}
2491 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2492 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2493 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2495 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2496 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2498 @opindex --output-tabs
2500 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2501 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2502 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2508 @opindex --join-lines
2509 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2510 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2511 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2512 no column alignment used; may be used with
2513 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2514 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2515 to disentangle the old (POSIX-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2516 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2519 @item -l @var{page_length}
2520 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2523 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2524 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2525 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2526 @option{-t} option had been given.
2532 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2533 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2534 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2536 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2537 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2538 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2539 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2540 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2541 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2542 the middle blank part.
2544 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2545 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2547 @opindex --number-lines
2548 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2549 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2550 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2551 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2552 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2553 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2554 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2555 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2556 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2557 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2558 printed with single column output only. The TAB width varies
2559 with the TAB position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2560 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2561 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a POSIX specification).
2562 The TAB width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2563 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2564 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2565 @var{number-separator} TAB@. The tabification depends upon the output
2568 @item -N @var{line_number}
2569 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2571 @opindex --first-line-number
2572 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2573 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2575 @item -o @var{margin}
2576 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2579 @cindex indenting lines
2581 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2582 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2583 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2584 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2587 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2589 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2590 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2591 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2593 @item -s[@var{char}]
2594 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2596 @opindex --separator
2597 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2598 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2599 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2600 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2601 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2602 @option{-w} is set. This is a POSIX-compliant formulation.
2605 @item -S[@var{string}]
2606 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2608 @opindex --sep-string
2609 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2610 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2611 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2612 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2614 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2615 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}).
2616 If no @samp{@var{string}} argument is specified, @samp{""} is assumed.
2619 @itemx --omit-header
2621 @opindex --omit-header
2622 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2623 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2624 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2625 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2626 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2627 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2628 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2631 @itemx --omit-pagination
2633 @opindex --omit-pagination
2634 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2635 set in the input files.
2638 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2640 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2641 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2643 @item -w @var{page_width}
2644 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2647 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2648 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). The specified
2649 @var{page_width} is rounded down so that columns have equal width.
2650 @option{-s[CHAR]} turns off the default page width and any line truncation
2651 and column alignment.
2652 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2653 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2654 A POSIX-compliant formulation.
2656 @item -W @var{page_width}
2657 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2659 @opindex --page_width
2660 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters, honored with and
2661 without a column option. With a column option, the specified @var{page_width}
2662 is rounded down so that columns have equal width. Text lines are truncated,
2663 unless @option{-J} is used. Together with one of the three column options
2664 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2665 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2666 don't disable the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2667 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2668 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2669 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}@. The header
2670 line is never truncated.
2677 @node fold invocation
2678 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2681 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2682 @cindex folding long input lines
2684 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2685 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2689 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2692 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2693 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2695 @cindex screen columns
2696 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2697 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2698 return sets the column to zero.
2700 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2708 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2709 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2716 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2717 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2718 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2720 @item -w @var{width}
2721 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2724 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2726 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2727 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2735 @node Output of parts of files
2736 @chapter Output of parts of files
2738 @cindex output of parts of files
2739 @cindex parts of files, output of
2741 These commands output pieces of the input.
2744 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2745 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2746 * split invocation:: Split a file into pieces.
2747 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2750 @node head invocation
2751 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2754 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2755 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2757 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2758 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2759 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2762 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2765 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2766 one-line header consisting of:
2769 ==> @var{file name} <==
2773 before the output for each @var{file}.
2775 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2780 @itemx --bytes=@var{k}
2783 Print the first @var{k} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2784 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{-},
2785 print all but the last @var{k} bytes of each file.
2786 @multiplierSuffixes{k}
2789 @itemx --lines=@var{k}
2792 Output the first @var{k} lines.
2793 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{-},
2794 print all but the last @var{k} lines of each file.
2795 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2803 Never print file name headers.
2809 Always print file name headers.
2813 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2814 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2815 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2816 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2817 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2818 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2819 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2820 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2821 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2827 @node tail invocation
2828 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2831 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2833 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2834 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2835 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2838 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2841 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2842 one-line header consisting of:
2845 ==> @var{file name} <==
2849 before the output for each @var{file}.
2851 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2852 GNU @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2853 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2854 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2855 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2856 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2857 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2858 the GNU @command{tac} command.
2860 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2865 @itemx --bytes=@var{k}
2868 Output the last @var{k} bytes, instead of final lines.
2869 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2870 @var{k}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2871 @multiplierSuffixes{k}
2874 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2877 @cindex growing files
2878 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2879 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2880 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2881 presumably because the file is growing.
2882 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2883 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2886 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2887 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2889 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2890 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2891 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2892 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2893 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file, perhaps by reopening it
2894 periodically to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2895 Note that the inotify-based implementation handles this case without
2896 the need for any periodic reopening.
2898 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2899 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2900 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2902 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2903 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2904 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2905 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2906 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2907 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2908 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2909 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2912 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2913 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2915 The @option{-f} option is ignored if
2916 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2917 Likewise, the @option{-f} option has no effect for any
2918 operand specified as @samp{-}, when standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2920 With kernel inotify support, output is triggered by file changes
2921 and is generally very prompt.
2922 Otherwise, @command{tail} sleeps for one second between checks---
2923 use @option{--sleep-interval=@var{n}} to change that default---which can
2924 make the output appear slightly less responsive or bursty.
2925 When using tail without inotify support, you can make it more responsive
2926 by using a sub-second sleep interval, e.g., via an alias like this:
2929 alias tail='tail -s.1'
2934 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2935 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2936 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2940 Indefinitely try to open the specified file.
2941 This option is useful mainly when following (and otherwise issues a warning).
2943 When following by file descriptor (i.e., with @option{--follow=descriptor}),
2944 this option only affects the initial open of the file, as after a successful
2945 open, @command{tail} will start following the file descriptor.
2947 When following by name (i.e., with @option{--follow=name}), @command{tail}
2948 infinitely retries to re-open the given files until killed.
2950 Without this option, when @command{tail} encounters a file that doesn't
2951 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2952 never checks it again.
2954 @item --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2955 @opindex --sleep-interval
2956 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2957 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2959 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2960 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2961 an arbitrary floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
2962 When @command{tail} uses inotify, this polling-related option
2963 is usually ignored. However, if you also specify @option{--pid=@var{p}},
2964 @command{tail} checks whether process @var{p} is alive at least
2965 every @var{number} seconds.
2967 @item --pid=@var{pid}
2969 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2970 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2971 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2972 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2973 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2974 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2975 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2976 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2980 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2983 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2984 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2985 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2986 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2987 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2988 will print a warning if this is the case.
2990 @item --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2991 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2992 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2993 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2994 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2995 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2996 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2997 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2998 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2999 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
3000 This option is meaningful only when polling (i.e., without inotify)
3001 and when following by name.
3004 @itemx --lines=@var{k}
3007 Output the last @var{k} lines.
3008 However, if @var{k} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
3009 @var{k}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
3010 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3018 Never print file name headers.
3024 Always print file name headers.
3028 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
3029 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
3030 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
3031 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
3032 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
3033 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
3034 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
3035 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
3037 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3038 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
3039 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
3040 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
3041 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
3042 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3045 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
3046 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
3047 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
3048 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
3049 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
3050 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
3051 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
3052 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
3054 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
3055 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the POSIX
3056 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
3057 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
3058 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
3059 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
3060 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
3065 @node split invocation
3066 @section @command{split}: Split a file into pieces.
3069 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
3070 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
3072 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive or interleaved
3073 sections of @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input}
3074 is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3077 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
3080 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
3081 left over for the last section), into each output file.
3083 @cindex output file name prefix
3084 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
3085 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
3086 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
3087 sorted order by file name produces the original input file (except
3088 @option{-nr/@var{n}}). By default split will initially create files
3089 with two generated suffix characters, and will increase this width by two
3090 when the next most significant position reaches the last character.
3091 (@samp{yz}, @samp{zaaa}, @samp{zaab}, @dots{}). In this way an arbitrary
3092 number of output files are supported, which sort as described above,
3093 even in the presence of an @option{--additional-suffix} option.
3094 If the @option{-a} option is specified and the output file names are
3095 exhausted, @command{split} reports an error without deleting the
3096 output files that it did create.
3098 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3102 @item -l @var{lines}
3103 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
3106 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
3107 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3108 the number of records.
3110 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
3111 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use
3112 @option{-l @var{lines}} instead.
3115 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
3118 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
3119 @multiplierSuffixes{size}
3122 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
3124 @opindex --line-bytes
3125 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
3126 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines or records
3127 longer than @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
3128 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
3129 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3130 the number of records.
3132 @item --filter=@var{command}
3134 With this option, rather than simply writing to each output file,
3135 write through a pipe to the specified shell @var{command} for each output file.
3136 @var{command} should use the $FILE environment variable, which is set
3137 to a different output file name for each invocation of the command.
3138 For example, imagine that you have a 1TiB compressed file
3139 that, if uncompressed, would be too large to reside on disk,
3140 yet you must split it into individually-compressed pieces
3141 of a more manageable size.
3142 To do that, you might run this command:
3145 xz -dc BIG.xz | split -b200G --filter='xz > $FILE.xz' - big-
3148 Assuming a 10:1 compression ratio, that would create about fifty 20GiB files
3149 with names @file{big-aa.xz}, @file{big-ab.xz}, @file{big-ac.xz}, etc.
3151 @item -n @var{chunks}
3152 @itemx --number=@var{chunks}
3156 Split @var{input} to @var{chunks} output files where @var{chunks} may be:
3159 @var{n} generate @var{n} files based on current size of @var{input}
3160 @var{k}/@var{n} only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3161 l/@var{n} generate @var{n} files without splitting lines or records
3162 l/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3163 r/@var{n} like @samp{l} but use round robin distribution
3164 r/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but only output @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3167 Any excess bytes remaining after dividing the @var{input}
3168 into @var{n} chunks, are assigned to the last chunk.
3169 Any excess bytes appearing after the initial calculation are discarded
3170 (except when using @samp{r} mode).
3172 All @var{n} files are created even if there are fewer than @var{n} lines,
3173 or the @var{input} is truncated.
3175 For @samp{l} mode, chunks are approximately @var{input} size / @var{n}.
3176 The @var{input} is partitioned into @var{n} equal sized portions, with
3177 the last assigned any excess. If a line @emph{starts} within a partition
3178 it is written completely to the corresponding file. Since lines or records
3179 are not split even if they overlap a partition, the files written
3180 can be larger or smaller than the partition size, and even empty
3181 if a line/record is so long as to completely overlap the partition.
3183 For @samp{r} mode, the size of @var{input} is irrelevant,
3184 and so can be a pipe for example.
3186 @item -a @var{length}
3187 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
3189 @opindex --suffix-length
3190 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. If a @var{length} of 0 is specified,
3191 this is the same as if (any previous) @option{-a} was not specified, and
3192 thus enables the default behavior, which starts the suffix length at 2,
3193 and unless @option{-n} or @option{--numeric-suffixes=@var{from}} is
3194 specified, will auto increase the length by 2 as required.
3197 @itemx --numeric-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3199 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
3200 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters. The numerical
3201 suffix counts from @var{from} if specified, 0 otherwise.
3203 @var{from} is supported with the long form option, and is used to either set the
3204 initial suffix for a single run, or to set the suffix offset for independently
3205 split inputs, and consequently the auto suffix length expansion described above
3206 is disabled. Therefore you may also want to use option @option{-a} to allow
3207 suffixes beyond @samp{99}. Note if option @option{--number} is specified and
3208 the number of files is less than @var{from}, a single run is assumed and the
3209 minimum suffix length required is automatically determined.
3211 @item --additional-suffix=@var{suffix}
3212 @opindex --additional-suffix
3213 Append an additional @var{suffix} to output file names. @var{suffix}
3214 must not contain slash.
3217 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3219 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3220 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. This can happen
3221 with the @option{--number} option if a file is (truncated to be) shorter
3222 than the number requested, or if a line is so long as to completely
3223 span a chunk. The output file sequence numbers, always run consecutively
3224 even when this option is specified.
3226 @item -t @var{separator}
3227 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
3229 @opindex --separator
3230 @cindex line separator character
3231 @cindex record separator character
3232 Use character @var{separator} as the record separator instead of the default
3233 newline character (ASCII LF).
3234 To specify ASCII NUL as the separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0},
3235 e.g., @samp{split -t '\0'}.
3240 @opindex --unbuffered
3241 Immediately copy input to output in @option{--number r/@dots{}} mode,
3242 which is a much slower mode of operation.
3246 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
3252 Here are a few examples to illustrate how the
3253 @option{--number} (@option{-n}) option works:
3255 Notice how, by default, one line may be split onto two or more:
3258 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -n3 k; head xa?
3271 Use the "l/" modifier to suppress that:
3274 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nl/3 k; head xa?
3287 Use the "r/" modifier to distribute lines in a round-robin fashion:
3290 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nr/3 k; head xa?
3303 You can also extract just the Kth chunk.
3304 This extracts and prints just the 7th "chunk" of 33:
3307 $ seq 100 > k; split -nl/7/33 k
3314 @node csplit invocation
3315 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
3318 @cindex context splitting
3319 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
3321 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
3322 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3325 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
3328 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
3329 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
3330 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
3331 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
3332 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
3335 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
3336 output file after it has been created.
3338 The types of pattern arguments are:
3343 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
3344 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
3345 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
3346 file once for each repeat.
3348 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
3349 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
3350 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
3351 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
3352 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
3353 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
3354 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
3356 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
3357 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
3358 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
3360 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
3361 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
3362 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
3363 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3368 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3369 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3370 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3371 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3372 original input file.
3374 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3375 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3376 that it has created so far before it exits.
3378 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3382 @item -f @var{prefix}
3383 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3386 @cindex output file name prefix
3387 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3389 @item -b @var{suffix}
3390 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
3393 @cindex output file name suffix
3394 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3395 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3396 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3397 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
3398 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3399 binary unsigned integer argument to readable form. The format letters
3400 @samp{d} and @samp{i} are aliases for @samp{u}, and the
3401 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3402 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
3403 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3404 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3405 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3407 @item -n @var{digits}
3408 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3411 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3412 long instead of the default 2.
3417 @opindex --keep-files
3418 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3420 @item --suppress-matched
3421 @opindex --suppress-matched
3422 Do not output lines matching the specified @var{pattern}.
3423 I.e., suppress the boundary line from the start of the second
3424 and subsequent splits.
3427 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3429 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3430 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3431 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3432 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3433 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3434 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3445 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3451 Here is an example of its usage.
3452 First, create an empty directory for the exercise,
3459 Now, split the sequence of 1..14 on lines that end with 0 or 5:
3462 $ seq 14 | csplit - '/[05]$/' '@{*@}'
3468 Each number printed above is the size of an output
3469 file that csplit has just created.
3470 List the names of those output files:
3477 Use @command{head} to show their contents:
3502 Example of splitting input by empty lines:
3505 $ csplit --suppress-matched @var{input.txt} '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3509 @c TODO: "uniq" already supports "--group".
3510 @c when it gets the "--key" option, uncomment this example.
3512 @c Example of splitting input file, based on the value of column 2:
3515 @c $ cat @var{input.txt} |
3517 @c uniq --group -k2,2 |
3518 @c csplit -m '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3521 @node Summarizing files
3522 @chapter Summarizing files
3524 @cindex summarizing files
3526 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3530 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3531 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3532 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3533 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3534 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3535 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3540 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3544 @cindex character count
3548 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3549 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3550 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3553 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3556 @cindex total counts
3557 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3558 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3559 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3560 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3561 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3562 maximum line length.
3563 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3564 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3565 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3566 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3567 However, as a GNU extension, if only one count is printed,
3568 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3570 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3571 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3572 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3579 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3581 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3582 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3583 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths. The line lengths here
3584 are measured in screen columns, according to the current locale and
3585 assuming tab positions in every 8th column.
3587 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3595 Print only the byte counts.
3601 Print only the character counts.
3607 Print only the word counts.
3613 Print only the newline counts.
3616 @itemx --max-line-length
3618 @opindex --max-line-length
3619 Print only the maximum display widths.
3620 Tabs are set at every 8th column.
3621 Display widths of wide characters are considered.
3622 Non-printable characters are given 0 width.
3624 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3625 @item --files0-from=@var{file}
3626 @opindex --files0-from=@var{file}
3627 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3628 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3629 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3630 Disallow processing files named on the command line, and instead process
3631 those named in file @var{file}; each name being terminated by a zero byte
3633 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3634 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3636 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3637 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3638 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3639 One way to produce a list of ASCII NUL terminated file
3641 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3642 If @var{file} is @samp{-} then the ASCII NUL terminated
3643 file names are read from standard input.
3645 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3647 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3648 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3651 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3652 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3660 @node sum invocation
3661 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3664 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3665 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3667 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3668 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3671 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3674 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3675 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3676 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3677 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3678 at least one file argument.)
3680 By default, GNU @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3681 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3684 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3690 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3691 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3692 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3693 given, it has no effect.
3699 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3700 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3701 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3705 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3706 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3711 @node cksum invocation
3712 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3715 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3716 @cindex CRC checksum
3718 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3719 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3720 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3723 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3726 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3727 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3729 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3730 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3731 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3732 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3735 The CRC algorithm is specified by the POSIX standard. It is not
3736 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3737 previous section); it is more robust.
3739 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3745 @node md5sum invocation
3746 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3750 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3751 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3752 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3753 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3755 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3756 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3758 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3759 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3760 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3761 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered secure
3762 against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a given MD5
3763 fingerprint is considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how
3764 to modify certain files, including digital certificates, so that they
3765 appear valid when signed with an MD5 digest.
3766 For more secure hashes, consider using SHA-2. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3768 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3769 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3770 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3771 consistent. Synopsis:
3774 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3777 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs by default, the MD5 checksum,
3778 a space, a flag indicating binary or text input mode, and the file name.
3779 Binary mode is indicated with @samp{*}, text mode with @samp{ } (space).
3780 Binary mode is the default on systems where it's significant,
3781 otherwise text mode is the default.
3782 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3783 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3784 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3785 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3786 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3788 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3796 @cindex binary input files
3797 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3798 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3799 On systems like GNU that do not distinguish between binary
3800 and text files, this option merely flags each input mode as binary:
3801 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3802 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3803 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3807 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3808 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3809 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3810 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3811 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3812 Three input formats are supported. Either the default output
3813 format described above, the @option{--tag} output format,
3814 or the BSD reversed mode format which is similar to the default mode,
3815 but doesn't use a character to distinguish binary and text modes.
3817 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3818 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3819 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3820 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3821 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3822 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3823 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3824 a warning is issued to standard error.
3825 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3826 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3827 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3828 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3829 it exits successfully.
3833 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3834 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3835 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
3836 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
3837 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
3838 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
3842 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3843 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3844 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3845 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3846 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3848 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3849 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3850 indicating there was a failure.
3855 Output BSD style checksums, which indicate the checksum algorithm used.
3856 As a GNU extension, file names with problematic characters
3857 are escaped as described above, with the same escaping indicator of @samp{\}
3858 at the start of the line, being used.
3859 The @option{--tag} option implies binary mode, and is disallowed with
3860 @option{--text} mode as supporting that would unnecessarily complicate
3861 the output format, while providing little benefit.
3867 @cindex text input files
3868 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3869 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3870 This option is the default on systems like GNU that do not
3871 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3872 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3873 terminal. This mode is never defaulted to if @option{--tag} is used.
3879 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3880 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3881 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3886 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3887 When verifying checksums,
3888 if one or more input line is invalid,
3889 exit nonzero after all warnings have been issued.
3896 @node sha1sum invocation
3897 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3901 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3902 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3903 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3904 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3906 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3907 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3908 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3910 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3911 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3912 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3913 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3914 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3915 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3918 @node sha2 utilities
3919 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3926 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3927 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3928 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3929 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3930 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3931 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3932 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3933 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3934 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3935 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3936 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3937 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3938 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3939 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3940 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3941 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3943 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3944 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3945 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3946 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3947 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}
3948 and @command{sha1sum}.
3949 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3952 @node Operating on sorted files
3953 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3955 @cindex operating on sorted files
3956 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3958 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3961 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3962 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3963 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3964 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3965 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3966 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3970 @node sort invocation
3971 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3974 @cindex sorting files
3976 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3977 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3978 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3982 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3985 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3986 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3993 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3996 @cindex checking for sortedness
3997 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
3998 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
3999 exit with a status of 1.
4000 Otherwise, exit successfully.
4001 At most one input file can be given.
4004 @itemx --check=quiet
4005 @itemx --check=silent
4008 @cindex checking for sortedness
4009 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
4010 exit with status 1 otherwise.
4011 At most one input file can be given.
4012 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
4018 @cindex merging sorted files
4019 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
4020 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
4021 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
4026 @cindex sort stability
4027 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4028 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
4029 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
4030 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
4031 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
4032 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
4033 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
4034 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
4035 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
4036 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
4037 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
4038 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
4039 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
4043 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
4044 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
4045 use a non-POSIX locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
4046 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
4047 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
4048 environment variable to @samp{C}@. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
4049 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
4050 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
4051 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
4052 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
4053 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
4055 GNU @command{sort} (as specified for all GNU utilities) has no
4056 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
4057 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, GNU
4058 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
4059 part of the line for comparison purposes.
4061 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
4065 0 if no error occurred
4066 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
4067 2 if an error occurred
4071 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
4072 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
4073 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
4074 the environment variable.
4076 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
4077 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
4078 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
4079 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
4080 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-POSIX
4081 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
4082 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
4087 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
4089 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
4090 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
4092 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
4093 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4094 can change this. Note blanks may be ignored by your locale's collating
4095 rules, but without this option they will be significant for character
4096 positions specified in keys with the @option{-k} option.
4099 @itemx --dictionary-order
4101 @opindex --dictionary-order
4102 @cindex dictionary order
4103 @cindex phone directory order
4104 @cindex telephone directory order
4106 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
4107 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
4108 By default letters and digits are those of ASCII and a blank
4109 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
4112 @itemx --ignore-case
4114 @opindex --ignore-case
4115 @cindex ignoring case
4116 @cindex case folding
4118 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
4119 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
4120 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4121 When used with @option{--unique} those lower case equivalent lines are
4122 thrown away. (There is currently no way to throw away the upper case
4123 equivalent instead. (Any @option{--reverse} given would only affect
4124 the final result, after the throwing away.))
4127 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
4128 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
4130 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
4132 @cindex general numeric sort
4134 Sort numerically, converting a prefix of each line to a long
4135 double-precision floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
4136 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
4137 Use the following collating sequence:
4141 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
4143 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
4144 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
4148 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
4153 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
4154 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
4155 converting to floating point.
4158 @itemx --human-numeric-sort
4159 @itemx --sort=human-numeric
4161 @opindex --human-numeric-sort
4163 @cindex human numeric sort
4165 Sort numerically, first by numeric sign (negative, zero, or positive);
4166 then by SI suffix (either empty, or @samp{k} or @samp{K}, or
4167 one of @samp{MGTPEZY}, in that order; @pxref{Block size}); and finally
4168 by numeric value. For example, @samp{1023M} sorts before @samp{1G}
4169 because @samp{M} (mega) precedes @samp{G} (giga) as an SI
4170 suffix. This option sorts values that are consistently scaled to the
4171 nearest suffix, regardless of whether suffixes denote powers of 1000
4172 or 1024, and it therefore sorts the output of any single invocation of
4173 the @command{df}, @command{du}, or @command{ls} commands that are
4174 invoked with their @option{--human-readable} or @option{--si} options.
4175 The syntax for numbers is the same as for the @option{--numeric-sort}
4176 option; the SI suffix must immediately follow the number.
4177 Note also the @command{numfmt} command, which can be used to reformat
4178 numbers to human format @emph{after} the sort, thus often allowing
4179 sort to operate on more accurate numbers.
4182 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
4184 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
4185 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
4186 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
4188 Ignore nonprinting characters.
4189 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4190 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
4191 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
4197 @opindex --month-sort
4199 @cindex months, sorting by
4201 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
4202 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
4203 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}@.
4204 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
4205 category determines the month spellings.
4206 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4210 @itemx --numeric-sort
4211 @itemx --sort=numeric
4213 @opindex --numeric-sort
4215 @cindex numeric sort
4217 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
4218 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
4219 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
4220 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
4221 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
4222 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
4223 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4226 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
4228 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
4229 To compare such strings numerically, use the
4230 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
4233 @itemx --version-sort
4235 @opindex --version-sort
4236 @cindex version number sort
4237 Sort by version name and number. It behaves like a standard sort,
4238 except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
4239 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
4245 @cindex reverse sorting
4246 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
4247 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
4250 @itemx --random-sort
4251 @itemx --sort=random
4253 @opindex --random-sort
4256 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
4257 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
4258 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
4259 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
4260 except that keys with the same value sort together.
4262 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
4263 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
4264 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
4267 The choice of hash function is affected by the
4268 @option{--random-source} option.
4276 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
4277 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
4279 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
4280 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
4281 standard input to standard output.
4283 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
4285 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
4286 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
4288 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
4290 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4291 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4295 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
4296 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
4297 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
4299 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
4300 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
4301 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
4302 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
4303 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
4304 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
4305 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
4306 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
4307 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
4310 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
4311 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more notes on keys and more examples.
4312 See also the @option{--debug} option to help determine the part
4313 of the line being used in the sort.
4316 Highlight the portion of each line used for sorting.
4317 Also issue warnings about questionable usage to stderr.
4319 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
4320 @opindex --batch-size
4321 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
4322 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
4324 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
4325 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
4326 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
4328 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
4329 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
4330 and I/O@. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
4331 requirements and I/O at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
4334 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2. The default value is
4335 currently 16, but this is implementation-dependent and may change in
4338 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
4339 file descriptors. The commands @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf
4340 OPEN_MAX} may display limits for your systems; these limits may be
4341 modified further if your program already has some files open, or if
4342 the operating system has other limits on the number of open files. If
4343 the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds the resource limit, @command{sort}
4344 silently uses a smaller value.
4346 @item -o @var{output-file}
4347 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4350 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4351 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4352 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
4353 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
4354 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}@.
4355 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
4356 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
4357 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
4358 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
4360 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4361 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
4362 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}@. Portable
4363 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
4366 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4367 @opindex --random-source
4368 @cindex random source for sorting
4369 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4370 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
4377 @cindex sort stability
4378 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4380 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
4381 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
4382 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
4385 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
4387 @opindex --buffer-size
4388 @cindex size for main memory sorting
4389 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
4390 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
4391 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
4392 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
4393 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
4394 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}@. Appending
4395 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
4398 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
4399 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
4400 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
4401 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
4404 @item -t @var{separator}
4405 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
4407 @opindex --field-separator
4408 @cindex field separator character
4409 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
4410 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
4411 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
4412 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4415 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
4416 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
4417 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
4418 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
4419 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
4420 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
4421 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
4422 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
4424 To specify ASCII NUL as the field separator,
4425 use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g., @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
4427 @item -T @var{tempdir}
4428 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
4430 @opindex --temporary-directory
4431 @cindex temporary directory
4433 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
4434 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
4435 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
4436 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
4437 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
4438 disks and controllers.
4440 @item --parallel=@var{n}
4442 @cindex multithreaded sort
4443 Set the number of sorts run in parallel to @var{n}. By default,
4444 @var{n} is set to the number of available processors, but limited
4445 to 8, as there are diminishing performance gains after that.
4446 Note also that using @var{n} threads increases the memory usage by
4447 a factor of log @var{n}. Also see @ref{nproc invocation}.
4453 @cindex uniquifying output
4455 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
4456 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
4457 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
4459 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
4461 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
4462 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
4463 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
4464 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
4465 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
4471 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
4472 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
4473 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}.
4474 GNU sort follows the POSIX
4475 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
4476 According to POSIX, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
4477 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
4478 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
4479 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
4481 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
4482 of the option letters @samp{MbdfghinRrV} appended to it, in which case no
4483 global ordering options are inherited by that particular field. The
4484 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
4485 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
4486 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
4487 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
4488 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b} or
4489 an option that implicitly ignores leading blanks (@samp{Mghn}) as otherwise
4490 the varying numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
4492 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
4493 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
4494 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
4495 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
4497 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4498 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4499 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
4500 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
4501 The obsolete sequence @samp{sort +@var{a}.@var{x} -@var{b}.@var{y}}
4502 is equivalent to @samp{sort -k @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b}} if @var{y}
4503 is @samp{0} or absent, otherwise it is equivalent to @samp{sort -k
4504 @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b+1}.@var{y}}.
4506 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4507 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4508 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
4509 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
4511 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
4512 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
4513 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
4514 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
4515 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
4516 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
4519 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
4524 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
4531 Run no more than 4 sorts concurrently, using a buffer size of 10M.
4534 sort --parallel=4 -S 10M
4538 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
4539 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
4540 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
4541 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
4542 and extending to the end of each line.
4549 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
4550 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
4551 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
4554 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
4557 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
4558 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
4559 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
4560 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
4561 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
4563 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
4564 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
4565 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
4566 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
4567 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
4568 field-end part of the key specifier.
4571 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
4572 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
4573 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
4577 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4578 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
4579 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
4582 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
4583 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
4584 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
4585 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
4586 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
4587 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
4588 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
4592 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
4593 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
4594 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
4595 files contain lines that look like this:
4598 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
4599 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
4602 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
4603 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
4604 because 61 is less than 129.
4607 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
4608 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
4611 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
4612 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
4613 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
4614 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
4615 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
4616 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
4617 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
4618 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
4619 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
4620 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
4621 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
4622 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
4626 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
4629 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
4632 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
4633 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
4635 by the sort operation.
4637 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
4639 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
4640 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
4641 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
4644 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n' |
4645 @c perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g' |
4647 @c perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
4651 Use the common DSU, Decorate Sort Undecorate idiom to
4652 sort lines according to their length.
4655 awk '@{print length, $0@}' /etc/passwd | sort -n | cut -f2- -d' '
4658 In general this technique can be used to sort data that the @command{sort}
4659 command does not support, or is inefficient at, sorting directly.
4662 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
4663 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
4664 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
4668 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
4674 @node shuf invocation
4675 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
4678 @cindex shuffling files
4680 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
4681 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
4685 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
4686 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
4687 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4690 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4691 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4692 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4700 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4701 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4703 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4704 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4706 @opindex --input-range
4707 @cindex input range to shuffle
4708 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4709 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4713 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4718 @item -n @var{lines}
4719 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
4721 @opindex --head-count
4722 @cindex head of output
4723 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
4726 @item -o @var{output-file}
4727 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4730 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4731 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4732 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4733 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4734 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4736 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4737 @opindex --random-source
4738 @cindex random source for shuffling
4739 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4740 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4746 @cindex repeat output values
4747 Repeat output values, that is, select with replacement. With this
4748 option the output is not a permutation of the input; instead, each
4749 output line is randomly chosen from all the inputs. This option is
4750 typically combined with @option{--head-count}; if
4751 @option{--head-count} is not given, @command{shuf} repeats
4770 might produce the output
4780 Similarly, the command:
4783 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4797 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4807 The above examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4808 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4809 general, if there are @var{n} input lines, there are @var{n}! (i.e.,
4810 @var{n} factorial, or @var{n} * (@var{n} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4811 output permutations.
4814 To output 50 random numbers each in the range 0 through 9, use:
4817 shuf -r -n 50 -i 0-9
4821 To simulate 100 coin flips, use:
4824 shuf -r -n 100 -e Head Tail
4830 @node uniq invocation
4831 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4834 @cindex uniquify files
4836 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4837 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4841 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4844 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4845 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4846 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4847 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4849 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4850 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4851 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4852 @xref{sort invocation}.
4855 Comparisons honor the rules specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE}
4858 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4861 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4866 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4868 @opindex --skip-fields
4869 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4870 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4871 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4872 each other by at least one space or tab.
4874 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4875 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4878 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4880 @opindex --skip-chars
4881 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4882 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4883 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4885 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4886 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4888 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4889 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4890 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4891 behavior depends on this variable.
4892 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4893 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4899 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4902 @itemx --ignore-case
4904 @opindex --ignore-case
4905 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4911 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4912 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4913 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4917 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4919 @opindex --all-repeated
4920 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4921 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4922 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4923 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4924 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4925 The optional @var{delimit-method}, supported with the long form option,
4926 specifies how to delimit groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the
4932 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4933 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4936 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4937 @macro nulOutputNote
4938 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
4939 byte (ASCII NUL) instead of a newline as the delimiter.
4944 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4945 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4946 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4947 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4951 @macro ambiguousGroupNote
4952 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4953 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4954 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\\n'} to replace
4955 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4959 This is a GNU extension.
4960 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4962 @item --group[=@var{delimit-method}]
4964 @cindex all lines, grouping
4965 Output all lines, and delimit each unique group.
4967 The optional @var{delimit-method} specifies how to delimit
4968 groups, and must be one of the following:
4973 Separate unique groups with a single delimiter.
4974 This is the default delimiting method if none is specified,
4975 and better suited for output direct to users.
4978 Output a delimiter before each group of unique items.
4981 Output a delimiter after each group of unique items.
4984 Output a delimiter around each group of unique items.
4989 This is a GNU extension.
4995 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4996 Discard the last line that would be output for a repeated input group.
4997 When used by itself, this option causes @command{uniq} to print unique
4998 lines, and nothing else.
5001 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
5003 @opindex --check-chars
5004 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
5005 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
5015 @node comm invocation
5016 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
5019 @cindex line-by-line comparison
5020 @cindex comparing sorted files
5022 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
5023 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
5024 standard input. Synopsis:
5027 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5031 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
5032 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
5033 If an input file ends in a non-newline
5034 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
5035 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
5037 @cindex differing lines
5038 @cindex common lines
5039 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
5040 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
5041 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
5042 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
5043 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
5044 @c string, append "by default" to the above sentence.
5049 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
5050 the corresponding columns (and separators). Also see @ref{Common options}.
5052 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
5053 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
5054 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
5055 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
5057 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
5058 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5059 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5060 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If neither
5061 of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5062 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable
5064 lines, and when both input files are non empty.
5066 @ifclear JOIN_COMMAND
5069 If an input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\}
5070 command will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5072 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
5073 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5074 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5075 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5077 @checkOrderOption{comm}
5082 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5084 @item --nocheck-order
5085 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
5089 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
5090 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
5091 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
5093 The delimiter @var{str} may not be empty.
5097 @node ptx invocation
5098 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
5102 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
5103 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
5106 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
5107 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5110 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
5111 all GNU extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
5112 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
5113 When @option{-G} is not specified, GNU extensions are always enabled.
5114 GNU extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
5115 document. @xref{Compatibility in ptx}, for the full list.
5117 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
5119 When GNU extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
5120 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
5121 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
5122 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
5123 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
5124 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
5125 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
5126 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
5129 When GNU extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
5130 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
5131 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
5132 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
5133 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
5134 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
5135 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
5136 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
5137 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
5138 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
5139 compatibility; GNU Standards normally discourage output parameters not
5140 introduced by an option.
5142 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
5143 input text file, a single dash @samp{-} may be used, in which case
5144 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
5145 convention more than once per program invocation.
5148 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
5149 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
5150 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
5151 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
5152 * Compatibility in ptx::
5156 @node General options in ptx
5157 @subsection General options
5162 @itemx --traditional
5163 As already explained, this option disables all GNU extensions to
5164 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
5167 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
5171 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
5179 @node Charset selection in ptx
5180 @subsection Charset selection
5182 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
5183 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
5184 using 8-bit ISO 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
5185 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
5186 character set of the IBM-PC@. (GNU @command{ptx} is not known to work on
5187 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit ASCII, the set
5188 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
5189 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
5190 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
5191 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
5197 @itemx --ignore-case
5198 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
5203 @node Input processing in ptx
5204 @subsection Word selection and input processing
5209 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
5211 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
5212 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
5213 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
5214 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
5215 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
5216 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
5217 @option{-b} is ignored.
5219 When GNU extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
5220 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
5221 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When GNU extensions
5222 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
5223 characters even if not included in the Break file.
5226 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
5228 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5229 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
5230 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
5231 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
5235 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
5237 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5238 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
5239 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
5240 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
5241 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
5243 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
5244 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
5245 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
5250 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
5251 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
5252 line in the resulting permuted index.
5253 @xref{Output formatting in ptx},
5254 for more information about reference production.
5255 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
5257 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
5258 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
5259 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
5260 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when GNU extensions
5261 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
5262 excluded from the output contexts.
5264 @item -S @var{regexp}
5265 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
5267 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
5268 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
5269 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
5270 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
5271 default, when GNU extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
5272 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
5273 imported from GNU Emacs:
5276 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
5279 Whenever GNU extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
5280 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
5286 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
5287 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
5288 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
5289 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
5290 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5293 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
5294 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
5295 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
5296 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
5297 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
5298 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
5299 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
5300 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
5301 on the right of the output line.
5303 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5304 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
5305 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5307 @item -W @var{regexp}
5308 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
5310 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
5311 By default, if GNU extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
5312 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When GNU extensions are
5313 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
5314 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
5316 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
5317 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5320 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5321 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5322 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5327 @node Output formatting in ptx
5328 @subsection Output formatting
5330 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
5331 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
5332 selected, and if GNU extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
5333 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
5334 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
5335 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
5336 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
5337 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
5338 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
5339 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with GNU
5340 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
5341 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
5342 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
5343 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
5344 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
5345 characters is transmitted verbatim.
5347 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
5351 @item -g @var{number}
5352 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
5354 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
5357 @item -w @var{number}
5358 @itemx --width=@var{number}
5360 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
5361 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
5362 depending on the value of option @option{-R}@. If this option is not
5363 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
5364 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
5365 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
5366 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
5367 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
5371 @itemx --auto-reference
5373 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
5374 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
5375 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
5376 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
5377 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
5378 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
5381 @itemx --right-side-refs
5383 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
5384 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
5385 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
5386 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
5387 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
5388 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
5389 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
5390 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
5392 This option is automatically selected whenever GNU extensions are
5395 @item -F @var{string}
5396 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
5398 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
5399 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
5400 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
5401 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}@. But there is a maximum
5402 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
5403 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
5404 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
5405 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
5406 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
5408 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F @dots{}}.
5409 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
5410 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
5413 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5414 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5415 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5417 @item -M @var{string}
5418 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
5420 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
5421 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
5424 @itemx --format=roff
5426 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
5427 processing. Each output line will look like:
5430 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}"@c
5431 "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5434 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5435 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when GNU
5436 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5437 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5439 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5440 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
5441 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character @samp{"} is doubled
5442 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
5447 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
5448 line will look like:
5451 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@c
5452 @{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
5456 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
5457 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
5458 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
5459 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
5460 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
5463 In this output format, some special characters, like @samp{$}, @samp{%},
5464 @samp{&}, @samp{#} and @samp{_} are automatically protected with a
5465 backslash. Curly brackets @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} are protected with a
5466 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
5467 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
5468 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
5469 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
5470 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
5471 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
5472 and all other characters which are not part of ASCII, are merely
5473 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
5474 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
5475 processing for @TeX{}.
5480 @node Compatibility in ptx
5481 @subsection The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
5483 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
5484 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
5485 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
5486 options. Some GNU extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
5487 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about GNU extensions.
5488 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
5493 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
5494 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
5495 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
5496 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
5499 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
5500 practice which GNU avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
5501 portably between GNU and System V, you should always use it with a
5502 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
5503 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
5504 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
5505 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
5508 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
5509 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
5510 @option{-w}. All other options are GNU extensions and are not repeated in
5511 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
5512 meaning when GNU extensions are enabled, as explained below.
5515 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
5516 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
5517 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
5520 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
5521 subtracted from the total output line width. With GNU extensions
5522 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
5523 line width computations.
5526 All 256 bytes, even ASCII NUL bytes, are always read and
5527 processed from input file with no adverse effect, even if GNU extensions
5528 are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit
5529 characters, a few control characters are rejected, and the tilde
5530 @samp{~} is also rejected.
5533 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if GNU
5534 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
5535 the first 200 characters in each line.
5538 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
5539 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When GNU
5540 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
5544 The program makes better use of output line width. If GNU extensions
5545 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
5546 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
5547 not completely reproduce.
5550 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
5551 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
5556 @node tsort invocation
5557 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
5560 @cindex topological sort
5562 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
5563 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
5564 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
5568 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
5571 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
5572 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
5573 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
5587 will produce the output
5598 Consider a more realistic example.
5599 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
5600 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
5601 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
5602 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
5603 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
5604 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
5605 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
5606 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
5607 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
5608 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
5609 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
5610 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
5616 tail_file pretty_name
5617 tail_file write_header
5619 tail_forever recheck
5620 tail_forever pretty_name
5621 tail_forever write_header
5622 tail_forever dump_remainder
5625 tail_lines start_lines
5626 tail_lines dump_remainder
5627 tail_lines file_lines
5628 tail_lines pipe_lines
5630 tail_bytes start_bytes
5631 tail_bytes dump_remainder
5632 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
5633 file_lines dump_remainder
5637 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
5638 functions that satisfies your requirement.
5641 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
5661 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
5662 encountered to standard error.
5664 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
5665 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
5666 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
5667 precedes @code{main}.
5669 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
5675 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
5678 @node tsort background
5679 @subsection @command{tsort}: Background
5681 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
5682 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
5683 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
5684 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
5687 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
5688 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
5689 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
5690 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
5691 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
5692 reference to @code{read}.
5694 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
5695 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
5696 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
5697 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
5700 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
5701 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
5703 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
5704 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
5705 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
5706 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
5709 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
5710 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
5714 @node Operating on fields
5715 @chapter Operating on fields
5718 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
5719 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
5720 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
5724 @node cut invocation
5725 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
5728 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
5729 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
5733 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5736 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
5737 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
5738 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
5739 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
5740 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
5741 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
5742 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
5743 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
5744 is written exactly once.
5746 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
5751 @item -b @var{byte-list}
5752 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
5755 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
5756 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
5757 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
5758 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
5759 string between ranges of selected bytes.
5761 @item -c @var{character-list}
5762 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
5764 @opindex --characters
5765 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
5766 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
5767 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
5768 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
5769 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
5770 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
5773 @item -f @var{field-list}
5774 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5777 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5778 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5779 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5780 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified.
5782 Note @command{awk} supports more sophisticated field processing,
5783 and by default will use (and discard) runs of blank characters to
5784 separate fields, and ignore leading and trailing blanks.
5787 awk '{print $2}' # print the second field
5788 awk '{print $NF-1}' # print the penultimate field
5789 awk '{print $2,$1}' # reorder the first two fields
5793 In the unlikely event that @command{awk} is unavailable,
5794 one can use the @command{join} command, to process blank
5795 characters as @command{awk} does above.
5798 join -a1 -o 1.2 - /dev/null # print the second field
5799 join -a1 -o 1.2,1.1 - /dev/null # reorder the first two fields
5803 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5804 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5806 @opindex --delimiter
5807 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5808 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5812 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5815 @itemx --only-delimited
5817 @opindex --only-delimited
5818 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5819 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5821 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5822 @opindex --output-delimiter
5823 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5824 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5825 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5826 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5827 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5828 ranges of selected bytes.
5831 @opindex --complement
5832 This option is a GNU extension.
5833 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5834 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5835 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5836 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5837 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5844 @node paste invocation
5845 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5848 @cindex merging files
5850 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5851 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5852 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5858 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5872 Take lines sequentially from each file:
5880 Duplicate lines from a file:
5882 $ paste num2 let3 num2
5888 Intermix lines from stdin:
5890 $ paste - let3 - < num2
5896 Join consecutive lines with a space:
5898 $ seq 4 | paste -d ' ' - -
5903 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5911 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5912 file. Using the above example data:
5915 $ paste -s num2 let3
5920 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5921 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5923 @opindex --delimiters
5924 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5925 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5926 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5929 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5940 @node join invocation
5941 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5944 @cindex common field, joining on
5946 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5947 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5950 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5953 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5954 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5955 sorted on the join fields.
5958 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5959 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5960 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5961 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5962 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5963 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5965 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5966 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5967 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5968 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5969 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5970 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5971 If @samp{join -t ''} is specified then the whole line is considered which
5972 matches the default operation of sort.
5974 If the input has no unpairable lines, a GNU extension is
5975 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
5976 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
5977 considers them to be equal. For example:
5995 @checkOrderOption{join}
6000 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
6001 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
6002 blanks on the line ignored;
6003 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
6004 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
6005 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
6008 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6012 @item -a @var{file-number}
6014 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
6015 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
6018 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
6020 @item --nocheck-order
6021 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
6023 @item -e @var{string}
6025 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with @var{string}.
6026 I.e., missing fields specified with the @option{-12jo} options.
6030 Treat the first line of each input file as a header line. The header lines
6031 will be joined and printed as the first output line. If @option{-o} is used to
6032 specify output format, the header line will be printed according to the
6033 specified format. The header lines will not be checked for ordering even if
6034 @option{--check-order} is specified. Also if the header lines from each file
6035 do not match, the heading fields from the first file will be used.
6038 @itemx --ignore-case
6040 @opindex --ignore-case
6041 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
6042 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
6043 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
6045 @item -1 @var{field}
6047 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
6049 @item -2 @var{field}
6051 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
6053 @item -j @var{field}
6054 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
6056 @item -o @var{field-list}
6058 If the keyword @samp{auto} is specified, infer the output format from
6059 the first line in each file. This is the same as the default output format
6060 but also ensures the same number of fields are output for each line.
6061 Missing fields are replaced with the @option{-e} option and extra fields
6064 Otherwise, construct each output line according to the format in
6065 @var{field-list}. Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single
6066 character @samp{0} or has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m},
6067 is @samp{1} or @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
6069 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
6070 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
6071 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
6072 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
6073 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
6074 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
6075 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
6076 To give @command{join} that functionality, POSIX invented the @samp{0}
6077 field specification notation.
6079 The elements in @var{field-list}
6080 are separated by commas or blanks.
6081 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
6082 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
6083 2.2'} are equivalent.
6085 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
6086 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
6089 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
6090 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
6091 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
6092 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering. If @samp{join -t ''} is specified,
6093 the whole line is considered, matching the default operation of sort.
6094 If @samp{-t '\0'} is specified then the ASCII NUL
6095 character is used to delimit the fields.
6097 @item -v @var{file-number}
6098 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
6099 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
6108 @node Operating on characters
6109 @chapter Operating on characters
6111 @cindex operating on characters
6113 These commands operate on individual characters.
6116 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
6117 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
6118 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
6123 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
6130 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
6133 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
6134 one of the following operations:
6138 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
6140 squeeze repeated characters,
6144 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
6147 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
6148 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
6149 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
6150 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
6152 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
6154 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
6155 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
6156 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
6157 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
6158 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
6159 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
6160 the input contains encoding errors.
6162 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
6163 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
6168 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
6169 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
6170 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
6174 @node Character sets
6175 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
6177 @cindex specifying sets of characters
6179 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
6180 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
6181 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
6182 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
6183 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
6184 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
6188 @item Backslash escapes
6189 @cindex backslash escapes
6191 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
6209 The 8-bit character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
6210 octal digits. Note that @samp{\400} is interpreted as the two-byte
6211 sequence, @samp{\040} @samp{0}.
6216 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
6217 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
6218 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
6219 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
6224 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
6225 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
6226 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
6227 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
6229 GNU @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
6230 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
6231 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
6232 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
6233 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
6236 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
6237 portable. For example, on EBCDIC hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
6238 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
6239 are not contiguous as they are in ASCII@.
6240 If you can rely on a POSIX compliant version of @command{tr}, then
6241 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
6242 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
6245 @item Repeated characters
6246 @cindex repeated characters
6248 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
6249 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
6250 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
6251 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
6252 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
6253 octal, otherwise in decimal.
6255 @item Character classes
6256 @cindex character classes
6258 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
6259 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
6260 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
6261 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
6262 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
6263 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
6264 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
6265 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
6266 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
6267 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
6268 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
6280 Horizontal whitespace.
6289 Printable characters, not including space.
6295 Printable characters, including space.
6298 Punctuation characters.
6301 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
6310 @item Equivalence classes
6311 @cindex equivalence classes
6313 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
6314 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
6315 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
6316 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
6317 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in GNU @command{tr};
6318 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
6319 which is of no particular use.
6325 @subsection Translating
6327 @cindex translating characters
6329 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
6330 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
6331 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
6332 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
6333 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
6334 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
6335 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
6336 two commands are equivalent:
6343 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
6344 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
6347 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
6349 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
6353 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
6355 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
6356 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
6357 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
6359 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
6360 portable; POSIX says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
6361 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
6362 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
6363 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
6365 By default, GNU @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
6366 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
6367 GNU @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
6368 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
6370 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
6374 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
6378 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
6379 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
6383 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
6384 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
6385 Assuming a POSIX compliant @command{tr}, here is a better
6389 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6394 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
6396 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
6397 @cindex deleting characters
6399 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
6400 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
6402 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
6403 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
6404 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
6406 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
6407 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
6408 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6410 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
6411 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
6412 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
6414 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
6419 Remove all zero bytes:
6426 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
6427 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
6428 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
6431 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
6435 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
6442 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
6443 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
6444 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
6445 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
6446 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
6447 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
6448 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
6449 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
6455 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
6456 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
6461 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
6462 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
6468 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
6469 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
6470 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
6471 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
6472 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
6473 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
6474 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
6475 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
6476 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
6483 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
6489 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
6490 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
6496 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
6497 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
6502 @node expand invocation
6503 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
6506 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
6507 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
6509 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
6510 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
6511 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
6515 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6518 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
6519 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
6520 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
6521 tabs every 8 columns).
6523 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6527 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6528 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6531 @cindex tab stops, setting
6532 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
6533 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
6534 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
6535 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
6536 blanks as well as by commas.
6538 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
6539 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
6540 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
6546 @cindex initial tabs, converting
6547 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
6548 characters) on each line to spaces.
6555 @node unexpand invocation
6556 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
6560 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
6561 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
6562 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
6563 as many tab characters as needed. In the default POSIX
6564 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
6565 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
6568 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6571 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
6572 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
6573 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
6574 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
6577 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6581 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6582 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
6585 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
6586 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
6587 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
6588 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
6589 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
6591 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
6592 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
6593 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
6594 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
6595 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
6601 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
6602 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
6609 @node Directory listing
6610 @chapter Directory listing
6612 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
6613 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
6616 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
6617 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
6618 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
6619 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
6624 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
6627 @cindex directory listing
6629 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
6630 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
6631 arbitrarily, as usual.
6633 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
6634 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
6635 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
6636 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
6637 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
6638 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
6641 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
6642 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-POSIX
6643 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
6644 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
6645 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
6646 If standard output is
6647 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
6648 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
6649 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
6651 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
6652 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
6653 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
6654 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
6655 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
6657 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
6662 1 minor problems (e.g., failure to access a file or directory not
6663 specified as a command line argument. This happens when listing a
6664 directory in which entries are actively being removed or renamed.)
6665 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted, invalid option, failure
6666 to access a file or directory specified as a command line argument
6667 or a directory loop)
6670 Also see @ref{Common options}.
6673 * Which files are listed::
6674 * What information is listed::
6675 * Sorting the output::
6676 * Details about version sort::
6677 * General output formatting::
6678 * Formatting file timestamps::
6679 * Formatting the file names::
6683 @node Which files are listed
6684 @subsection Which files are listed
6686 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
6687 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
6688 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
6689 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
6697 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
6702 @opindex --almost-all
6703 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
6704 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
6705 option overrides this option.
6708 @itemx --ignore-backups
6710 @opindex --ignore-backups
6711 @cindex backup files, ignoring
6712 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
6713 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
6718 @opindex --directory
6719 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
6720 than listing their contents.
6721 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
6722 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6723 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6724 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6725 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6728 @itemx --dereference-command-line
6730 @opindex --dereference-command-line
6731 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6732 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
6733 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
6735 @item --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6736 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
6737 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6738 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
6739 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
6740 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
6742 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
6743 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
6744 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
6746 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6747 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
6749 @item --group-directories-first
6750 @opindex --group-directories-first
6751 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
6752 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
6753 (see --sort option).
6754 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
6755 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
6756 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
6757 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
6759 @item --hide=PATTERN
6760 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
6761 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6762 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
6763 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
6764 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
6765 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
6766 (@option{-A}) is also given.
6768 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
6769 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
6770 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
6771 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
6773 @item -I @var{pattern}
6774 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
6776 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
6777 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
6778 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
6779 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
6780 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
6781 to give this option several times. For example,
6784 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
6787 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
6788 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
6789 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
6792 @itemx --dereference
6794 @opindex --dereference
6795 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
6796 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
6797 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
6798 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
6799 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
6804 @opindex --recursive
6805 @cindex recursive directory listing
6806 @cindex directory listing, recursive
6807 List the contents of all directories recursively.
6812 @node What information is listed
6813 @subsection What information is listed
6815 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
6816 default, only file names are shown.
6822 @cindex hurd, author, printing
6823 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
6824 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
6825 operating systems the two are the same.
6831 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
6832 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
6836 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
6840 The @var{begn} and @var{endn} are unsigned integers that record the
6841 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
6842 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
6843 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
6845 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
6846 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
6849 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
6852 Finally, output a line of the form:
6855 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
6859 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
6861 Here is an actual example:
6864 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6866 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6867 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6870 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6871 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6872 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6873 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6877 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6881 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6885 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6886 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6887 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6890 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6891 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6893 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6894 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6896 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6897 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6900 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6901 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6905 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6906 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6907 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6908 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6909 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6914 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6915 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6917 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6920 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6921 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6922 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6923 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6924 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6925 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6926 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6929 @opindex --full-time
6930 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6931 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6932 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6936 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6942 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6943 (This is the default in some non-GNU versions of @command{ls}, so we
6944 provide this option for compatibility.)
6952 @cindex inode number, printing
6953 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6954 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6955 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6958 @itemx --format=long
6959 @itemx --format=verbose
6962 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6963 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6964 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6965 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6966 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6967 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6968 cannot be determined.
6970 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6971 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6972 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6973 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6974 separator of the current locale.
6976 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6977 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6978 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6979 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6980 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6981 this is arguably a deficiency.
6983 The file type is one of the following characters:
6985 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6993 character special file
6995 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
6999 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
7001 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
7005 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
7007 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
7009 network special file (HP-UX)
7013 port (Solaris 10 and up)
7015 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
7019 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7021 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7023 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
7025 some other file type
7028 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
7029 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
7030 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
7031 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
7035 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
7039 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
7040 executable bit is not set.
7043 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
7044 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
7045 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
7048 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
7049 other-executable bit is not set.
7052 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
7058 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
7059 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
7060 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
7061 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
7062 character, then there is such a method.
7064 GNU @command{ls} uses a @samp{.} character to indicate a file
7065 with a security context, but no other alternate access method.
7067 A file with any other combination of alternate access methods
7068 is marked with a @samp{+} character.
7071 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
7073 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
7074 @cindex numeric uid and gid
7075 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
7076 Produce long format directory listings, but
7077 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
7081 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
7082 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
7088 @cindex disk allocation
7089 @cindex size of files, reporting
7090 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
7091 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
7092 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
7094 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
7095 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7097 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
7098 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
7099 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
7100 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
7101 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
7102 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
7111 @cindex security context
7112 Display the SELinux security context or @samp{?} if none is found.
7113 When used with the @option{-l} option, print the security context
7114 to the left of the size column.
7119 @node Sorting the output
7120 @subsection Sorting the output
7122 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
7123 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
7124 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
7125 (e.g., ASCII order).
7131 @itemx --time=status
7134 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
7135 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
7136 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7137 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
7138 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
7139 the modification time.
7140 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
7141 or when not using a long listing format,
7142 sort according to the status change time.
7146 @cindex unsorted directory listing
7147 @cindex directory order, listing by
7148 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
7149 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
7150 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
7151 were specified before the @option{-f}).
7157 @cindex reverse sorting
7158 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
7159 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
7165 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
7166 Sort by file size, largest first.
7172 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
7173 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
7177 @itemx --time=access
7181 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7182 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7183 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
7184 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
7185 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
7186 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
7187 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
7193 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
7194 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
7195 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
7196 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
7197 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
7200 @itemx --sort=version
7203 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
7204 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
7205 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
7206 as an index/version number. (@xref{Details about version sort}.)
7209 @itemx --sort=extension
7212 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
7213 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
7214 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
7219 @node Details about version sort
7220 @subsection Details about version sort
7222 Version sorting handles the fact that file names frequently include indices or
7223 version numbers. Standard sorting usually does not produce the order that one
7224 expects because comparisons are made on a character-by-character basis.
7225 Version sorting is especially useful when browsing directories that contain
7226 many files with indices/version numbers in their names:
7230 abc.zml-1.gz abc.zml-1.gz
7231 abc.zml-12.gz abc.zml-2.gz
7232 abc.zml-2.gz abc.zml-12.gz
7235 Version-sorted strings are compared such that if @var{ver1} and @var{ver2}
7236 are version numbers and @var{prefix} and @var{suffix} (@var{suffix} matching
7237 the regular expression @samp{(\.[A-Za-z~][A-Za-z0-9~]*)*}) are strings then
7238 @var{ver1} < @var{ver2} implies that the name composed of
7239 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver1} @var{suffix}'' sorts before
7240 ``@var{prefix} @var{ver2} @var{suffix}''.
7242 Note also that leading zeros of numeric parts are ignored:
7246 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
7247 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
7248 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
7251 This functionality is implemented using gnulib's @code{filevercmp} function,
7252 which has some caveats worth noting.
7255 @item @env{LC_COLLATE} is ignored, which means @samp{ls -v} and @samp{sort -V}
7256 will sort non-numeric prefixes as if the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category
7257 was set to @samp{C}@.
7258 @item Some suffixes will not be matched by the regular
7259 expression mentioned above. Consequently these examples may
7260 not sort as you expect:
7268 abc-1.2.3.4.x86_64.rpm
7269 abc-1.2.3.x86_64.rpm
7273 @node General output formatting
7274 @subsection General output formatting
7276 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
7281 @itemx --format=single-column
7284 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
7285 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
7286 output is not a terminal. See also the @option{-b} and @option{-q} options
7287 to suppress direct output of newline characters within a file name.
7290 @itemx --format=vertical
7293 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
7294 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
7295 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
7296 for the @command{dir} program.
7297 GNU @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
7298 possible in the fewest lines.
7300 @item --color [=@var{when}]
7302 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
7303 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
7304 may be omitted, or one of:
7307 @vindex none @r{color option}
7308 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
7310 @vindex auto @r{color option}
7311 @cindex terminal, using color iff
7312 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
7314 @vindex always @r{color option}
7317 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
7318 @option{--color=always}.
7319 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
7320 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
7321 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
7324 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7325 Note that using the @option{--color} option may incur a noticeable
7326 performance penalty when run in a directory with very many entries,
7327 because the default settings require that @command{ls} @code{stat} every
7328 single file it lists.
7329 However, if you would like most of the file-type coloring
7330 but can live without the other coloring options (e.g.,
7331 executable, orphan, sticky, other-writable, capability), use
7332 @command{dircolors} to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment variable like this,
7334 eval $(dircolors -p | perl -pe \
7335 's/^((CAP|S[ET]|O[TR]|M|E)\w+).*/$1 00/' | dircolors -)
7337 and on a @code{dirent.d_type}-capable file system, @command{ls}
7338 will perform only one @code{stat} call per command line argument.
7342 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
7345 @opindex --indicator-style
7346 @cindex file type and executables, marking
7347 @cindex executables and file type, marking
7348 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
7349 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
7350 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
7351 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
7352 and nothing for regular files.
7353 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
7354 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
7355 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
7356 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7357 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
7360 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
7361 @opindex --file-type
7362 @opindex --indicator-style
7363 @cindex file type, marking
7364 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
7365 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
7367 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
7368 @opindex --indicator-style
7369 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
7374 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
7376 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
7379 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
7380 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
7381 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
7383 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
7384 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
7385 @option{--classify} option.
7391 @opindex --kibibytes
7392 Set the default block size to its normal value of 1024 bytes,
7393 overriding any contrary specification in environment variables
7394 (@pxref{Block size}). This option is in turn overridden by the
7395 @option{--block-size}, @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable}, and
7396 @option{--si} options.
7398 The @option{-k} or @option{--kibibytes} option affects the
7399 per-directory block count written by the @option{-l} and similar
7400 options, and the size written by the @option{-s} or @option{--size}
7401 option. It does not affect the file size written by @option{-l}.
7404 @itemx --format=commas
7407 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
7408 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
7409 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
7412 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
7414 @opindex --indicator-style
7415 @cindex file type, marking
7416 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
7419 @itemx --format=across
7420 @itemx --format=horizontal
7423 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
7424 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
7425 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
7428 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
7431 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
7432 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
7433 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
7435 Some terminal emulators might not properly align columns to the right of a
7436 TAB following a non-ASCII byte. You can avoid that issue by using the
7437 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment, to tell
7438 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
7441 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
7445 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
7446 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
7447 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
7448 is 80. With a @var{cols} value of @samp{0}, there is no limit on
7449 the length of the output line, and that single output line will
7450 be delimited with spaces, not tabs.
7455 @node Formatting file timestamps
7456 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
7458 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form, using
7459 a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} for non-recent timestamps, and a
7460 date-without-year and time like @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
7461 This format can change depending on the current locale as detailed below.
7464 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
7465 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
7466 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
7467 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
7468 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
7471 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
7472 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
7473 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
7474 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
7476 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
7479 @item --time-style=@var{style}
7480 @opindex --time-style
7482 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
7483 be one of the following:
7488 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
7489 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
7490 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
7491 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
7492 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
7493 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
7495 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
7496 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
7497 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
7498 spaces in one of the two formats.
7501 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601 date, time, and time zone
7502 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
7503 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
7504 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
7506 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
7507 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
7508 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since GNU @command{make}
7509 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
7512 List ISO 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
7513 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
7514 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
7515 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
7518 List ISO 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
7519 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and ISO 8601 month, day, hour, and
7520 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
7521 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
7522 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
7523 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
7524 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7529 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
7530 ls -l --time-style="iso"
7535 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
7536 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
7537 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
7538 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
7539 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
7540 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
7542 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
7543 default POSIX locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
7544 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
7545 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
7550 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
7551 ls -l --time-style="locale"
7554 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
7555 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
7556 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
7557 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
7558 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
7560 @item posix-@var{style}
7562 List POSIX-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
7563 category is POSIX, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
7564 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
7565 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
7566 the POSIX locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
7571 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
7572 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
7573 the default style is @samp{locale}. GNU Emacs 21.3 and
7574 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
7575 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
7576 non-POSIX locale you may need to set
7577 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
7579 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
7580 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
7583 @node Formatting the file names
7584 @subsection Formatting the file names
7586 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
7592 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
7595 @opindex --quoting-style
7596 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
7597 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
7598 backslash sequences like those used in C.
7602 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
7605 @opindex --quoting-style
7606 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
7607 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
7608 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
7612 @itemx --hide-control-chars
7614 @opindex --hide-control-chars
7615 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
7616 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
7621 @itemx --quoting-style=c
7623 @opindex --quote-name
7624 @opindex --quoting-style
7625 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
7628 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
7629 @opindex --quoting-style
7630 @cindex quoting style
7631 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
7632 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
7633 be one of the following:
7637 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
7638 @option{--literal} option.
7640 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
7641 cause ambiguous output.
7642 The quoting is suitable for POSIX-compatible shells like
7643 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
7646 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
7648 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
7649 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
7650 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
7652 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
7653 surrounding double-quote
7654 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
7656 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7657 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
7660 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
7661 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
7662 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
7663 @t{'like this'} instead of @t{"like
7664 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
7667 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
7668 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment
7669 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
7670 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
7672 @item --show-control-chars
7673 @opindex --show-control-chars
7674 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
7675 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
7681 @node dir invocation
7682 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
7685 @cindex directory listing, brief
7687 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
7688 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
7689 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7691 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
7694 @node vdir invocation
7695 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
7698 @cindex directory listing, verbose
7700 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
7701 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
7702 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
7704 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
7706 @node dircolors invocation
7707 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
7711 @cindex setup for color
7713 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
7714 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
7718 eval "$(dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}])"
7721 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
7722 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
7723 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
7724 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
7726 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
7727 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
7728 adapt them to your favorite shell):
7732 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
7736 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
7737 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
7738 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
7739 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
7740 environment variable.
7742 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7747 @itemx --bourne-shell
7750 @opindex --bourne-shell
7751 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
7752 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
7753 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
7754 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
7763 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
7764 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
7765 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
7766 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
7769 @itemx --print-database
7771 @opindex --print-database
7772 @cindex color database, printing
7773 @cindex database for color setup, printing
7774 @cindex printing color database
7775 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
7776 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
7777 of the possibilities.
7784 @node Basic operations
7785 @chapter Basic operations
7787 @cindex manipulating files
7789 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
7790 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
7793 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
7794 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
7795 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
7796 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
7797 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
7798 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
7803 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
7806 @cindex copying files and directories
7807 @cindex files, copying
7808 @cindex directories, copying
7810 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
7811 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
7812 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
7816 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7817 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7818 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7823 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
7827 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7828 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7829 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7830 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
7831 using the @var{source}s' names.
7834 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
7835 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
7837 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
7838 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
7839 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
7840 to corresponding destination directories.
7842 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
7843 link only when not copying recursively or when @option{--link}
7844 (@option{-l}) is used. This default can be overridden with the
7845 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
7846 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
7847 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
7848 the last one silently overrides the others.
7850 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
7851 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
7852 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
7853 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
7854 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
7855 practice and to POSIX@.
7856 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
7857 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
7858 Also, when an option like
7859 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
7860 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
7861 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
7863 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
7864 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
7865 @option{--copy-contents} option.
7867 @cindex self-backups
7868 @cindex backups, making only
7869 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
7870 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
7871 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
7872 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
7873 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
7874 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
7876 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7883 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
7884 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
7885 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
7886 directory in a different order).
7887 Try to preserve SELinux security context and extended attributes (xattr),
7888 but ignore any failure to do that and print no corresponding diagnostic.
7889 Equivalent to @option{-dR --preserve=all} with the reduced diagnostics.
7891 @item --attributes-only
7892 @opindex --attributes-only
7893 Copy only the specified attributes of the source file to the destination.
7894 If the destination already exists, do not alter its contents.
7895 See the @option{--preserve} option for controlling which attributes to copy.
7898 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
7901 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
7902 @cindex backups, making
7903 @xref{Backup options}.
7904 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
7905 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
7906 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
7907 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
7908 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
7912 # Usage: backup FILE...
7913 # Create a GNU-style backup of each listed FILE.
7916 cp --backup --force --preserve=all -- "$i" "$i" || fail=1
7921 @item --copy-contents
7922 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7923 @cindex copying directories recursively
7924 @cindex recursively copying directories
7925 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7926 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
7927 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
7928 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
7929 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
7930 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
7931 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
7932 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
7933 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
7934 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
7935 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
7936 affect the copying of symbolic links.
7940 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7941 @cindex hard links, preserving
7942 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7943 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7944 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7950 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7951 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force},
7952 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7953 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7954 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7955 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7956 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7958 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7959 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7961 This option is ignored when the @option{--no-clobber} or @option{-n} option
7966 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7967 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7968 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7969 via recursive traversal.
7972 @itemx --interactive
7974 @opindex --interactive
7975 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7976 overwrite an existing destination file. The @option{-i} option overrides
7977 a previous @option{-n} option.
7983 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7986 @itemx --dereference
7988 @opindex --dereference
7989 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7990 With this option, @command{cp} cannot create a symbolic link.
7991 For example, a symlink (to regular file) in the source tree will be copied to
7992 a regular file in the destination tree.
7997 @opindex --no-clobber
7998 Do not overwrite an existing file. The @option{-n} option overrides a previous
7999 @option{-i} option. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or
8000 @option{--backup} option.
8003 @itemx --no-dereference
8005 @opindex --no-dereference
8006 @cindex symbolic links, copying
8007 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
8008 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
8009 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
8012 @itemx --preserve[=@var{attribute_list}]
8015 @cindex file information, preserving, extended attributes, xattr
8016 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
8017 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
8018 of one or more of the following strings:
8022 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
8024 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
8025 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
8027 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
8028 a member of the desired group.
8030 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
8031 On older systems, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
8032 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
8033 However, many systems now provide the @code{utimensat} function,
8034 which makes it possible even for symbolic links.
8036 Preserve in the destination files
8037 any links between corresponding source files.
8038 Note that with @option{-L} or @option{-H}, this option can convert
8039 symbolic links to hard links. For example,
8041 $ mkdir c; : > a; ln -s a b; cp -aH a b c; ls -i1 c
8046 Note the inputs: @file{b} is a symlink to regular file @file{a},
8047 yet the files in destination directory, @file{c/}, are hard-linked.
8048 Since @option{-a} implies @option{--no-dereference} it would copy the symlink,
8049 but the later @option{-H} tells @command{cp} to dereference the command line
8050 arguments where it then sees two files with the same inode number.
8051 Then the @option{--preserve=links} option also implied by @option{-a}
8052 will preserve the perceived hard link.
8054 Here is a similar example that exercises @command{cp}'s @option{-L} option:
8056 $ mkdir b c; (cd b; : > a; ln -s a b); cp -aL b c; ls -i1 c/b
8062 Preserve SELinux security context of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
8064 Preserve extended attributes of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
8065 If @command{cp} is built without xattr support, ignore this option.
8066 If SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities are implemented using xattrs,
8067 they are preserved implicitly by this option as well, i.e., even without
8068 specifying @option{--preserve=mode} or @option{--preserve=context}.
8070 Preserve all file attributes.
8071 Equivalent to specifying all of the above, but with the difference
8072 that failure to preserve SELinux security context or extended attributes
8073 does not change @command{cp}'s exit status. In contrast to @option{-a},
8074 all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
8077 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
8078 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
8080 In the absence of this option, the permissions of existing destination
8081 files are unchanged. Each new file is created with the mode of the
8082 corresponding source file minus the set-user-ID, set-group-ID, and
8083 sticky bits as the create mode; the operating system then applies either
8084 the umask or a default ACL, possibly resulting in a more restrictive
8086 @xref{File permissions}.
8088 @item --no-preserve=@var{attribute_list}
8089 @cindex file information, preserving
8090 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
8091 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
8095 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
8096 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
8097 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
8098 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
8099 For example, the command:
8102 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
8106 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
8107 any missing intermediate directories.
8114 @opindex --recursive
8115 @cindex directories, copying recursively
8116 @cindex copying directories recursively
8117 @cindex recursively copying directories
8118 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
8119 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
8120 links in the source unless used together with the @option{--link}
8121 (@option{-l}) option; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
8122 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
8123 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
8124 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
8125 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
8126 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
8127 non-GNU systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
8128 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
8129 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
8130 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as POSIX allows
8131 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
8133 @item --reflink[=@var{when}]
8134 @opindex --reflink[=@var{when}]
8137 @cindex copy on write
8138 Perform a lightweight, copy-on-write (COW) copy, if supported by the
8139 file system. Once it has succeeded, beware that the source and destination
8140 files share the same disk data blocks as long as they remain unmodified.
8141 Thus, if a disk I/O error affects data blocks of one of the files,
8142 the other suffers the same fate.
8144 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
8148 The default behavior: if the copy-on-write operation is not supported
8149 then report the failure for each file and exit with a failure status.
8152 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported then fall back
8153 to the standard copy behavior.
8156 This option is overridden by the @option{--link}, @option{--symbolic-link}
8157 and @option{--attributes-only} options, thus allowing it to be used
8158 to configure the default data copying behavior for @command{cp}.
8159 For example, with the following alias, @command{cp} will use the
8160 minimum amount of space supported by the file system.
8163 alias cp='cp --reflink=auto --sparse=always'
8166 @item --remove-destination
8167 @opindex --remove-destination
8168 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
8169 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
8171 @item --sparse=@var{when}
8172 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
8173 @cindex sparse files, copying
8174 @cindex holes, copying files with
8175 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
8176 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
8177 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
8178 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
8179 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
8180 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
8181 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
8182 Only regular files may be sparse.
8184 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
8188 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
8189 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
8190 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
8193 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
8194 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
8195 input file does not appear to be sparse.
8196 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
8197 that does not support sparse files
8198 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
8199 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
8200 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
8201 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
8204 Never make the output file sparse.
8205 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
8206 since such a file must not have any holes.
8209 @optStripTrailingSlashes
8212 @itemx --symbolic-link
8214 @opindex --symbolic-link
8215 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
8216 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
8217 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
8218 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
8219 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8225 @optNoTargetDirectory
8231 @cindex newer files, copying only
8232 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
8233 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
8234 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
8235 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
8236 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
8237 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and destination.
8238 If @option{--preserve=links} is also specified (like with @samp{cp -au}
8239 for example), that will take precedence. Consequently, depending on the
8240 order that files are processed from the source, newer files in the destination
8241 may be replaced, to mirror hard links in the source.
8247 Print the name of each file before copying it.
8250 @itemx --one-file-system
8252 @opindex --one-file-system
8253 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
8254 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
8255 the copy started on.
8256 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
8260 @itemx --context[=@var{context}]
8263 @cindex SELinux, setting/restoring security context
8264 @cindex security context
8265 Without a specified @var{context}, adjust the SELinux security context according
8266 to the system default type for destination files, similarly to the
8267 @command{restorecon} command.
8268 The long form of this option with a specific context specified,
8269 will set the context for newly created files only.
8270 With a specified context, if both SELinux and SMACK are disabled, a warning is
8274 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve=context}
8275 option, and overrides the @option{--preserve=all} and @option{-a} options.
8283 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
8286 @cindex converting while copying a file
8288 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
8289 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
8290 conversions on it. Synopses:
8293 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
8297 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
8298 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands,
8299 whose syntax was inspired by the DD (data definition) statement of
8306 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
8310 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
8311 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
8312 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
8314 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
8316 @cindex block size of input
8317 @cindex input block size
8318 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
8319 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
8320 The default is 512 bytes.
8322 @item obs=@var{bytes}
8324 @cindex block size of output
8325 @cindex output block size
8326 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
8327 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
8328 The default is 512 bytes.
8330 @item bs=@var{bytes}
8333 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
8334 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
8335 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
8336 In addition, if no data-transforming @option{conv} option is specified,
8337 input is copied to the output as soon as it's read,
8338 even if it is smaller than the block size.
8340 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
8342 @cindex block size of conversion
8343 @cindex conversion block size
8344 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
8345 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
8346 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
8347 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
8348 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
8349 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
8353 Skip @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
8354 If @samp{iflag=skip_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8355 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8359 Skip @var{n} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
8360 if @samp{oflag=seek_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8361 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8365 Copy @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
8366 of everything until the end of the file.
8367 if @samp{iflag=count_bytes} is specified, @var{n} is interpreted
8368 as a byte count rather than a block count.
8369 Note if the input may return short reads as could be the case
8370 when reading from a pipe for example, @samp{iflag=fullblock}
8371 will ensure that @samp{count=} corresponds to complete input blocks
8372 rather than the traditional POSIX specified behavior of counting
8373 input read operations.
8375 @item status=@var{level}
8377 Transfer information is normally output to stderr upon
8378 receipt of the @samp{INFO} signal or when @command{dd} exits.
8379 Specifying @var{level} will adjust the amount of information printed,
8380 with the last @var{level} specified taking precedence.
8385 @opindex none @r{dd status=}
8386 Do not print any informational or warning messages to stderr.
8387 Error messages are output as normal.
8390 @opindex noxfer @r{dd status=}
8391 Do not print the final transfer rate and volume statistics
8392 that normally make up the last status line.
8395 @opindex progress @r{dd status=}
8396 Print the transfer rate and volume statistics on stderr,
8397 when processing each input block. Statistics are output
8398 on a single line at most once every second, but updates
8399 can be delayed when waiting on I/O.
8403 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
8405 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
8406 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8413 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
8414 Convert EBCDIC to ASCII,
8415 using the conversion table specified by POSIX@.
8416 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
8417 This option implies @samp{conv=unblock}; input is converted to
8418 ASCII before trailing spaces are deleted.
8421 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8422 Convert ASCII to EBCDIC@.
8423 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
8424 This option implies @samp{conv=block}; trailing spaces are added
8425 before being converted to EBCDIC@.
8428 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
8429 This acts like @samp{conv=ebcdic}, except it
8430 uses the alternate conversion table specified by POSIX@.
8431 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
8432 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
8434 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
8435 mutually exclusive. If you use any of these options, you should also
8436 use the @samp{cbs=} option.
8439 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
8440 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
8441 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
8445 Remove any trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block,
8446 and append a newline.
8448 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8451 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
8452 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
8455 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
8456 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
8458 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8462 Try to seek rather than write NUL output blocks.
8463 On a file system that supports sparse files, this will create
8464 sparse output when extending the output file.
8465 Be careful when using this option in conjunction with
8466 @samp{conv=notrunc} or @samp{oflag=append}.
8467 With @samp{conv=notrunc}, existing data in the output file
8468 corresponding to NUL blocks from the input, will be untouched.
8469 With @samp{oflag=append} the seeks performed will be ineffective.
8470 Similarly, when the output is a device rather than a file,
8471 NUL input blocks are not copied, and therefore this option
8472 is most useful with virtual or pre zeroed devices.
8475 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
8476 @cindex byte-swapping
8477 Swap every pair of input bytes. GNU @command{dd}, unlike others, works
8478 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
8479 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
8482 @opindex sync @r{(padding with ASCII NULs)}
8483 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
8484 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
8489 The following ``conversions'' are really file flags
8490 and don't affect internal processing:
8495 @cindex creating output file, requiring
8496 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
8501 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
8502 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
8504 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
8508 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
8509 Do not truncate the output file.
8513 @cindex read errors, ignoring
8514 Continue after read errors.
8518 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
8519 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
8520 write of output data.
8524 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
8525 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
8526 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
8530 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8532 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8533 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8535 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
8537 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
8538 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
8540 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
8547 @cindex appending to the output file
8548 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
8549 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
8550 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
8551 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
8552 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
8553 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
8557 @cindex concurrent I/O
8558 Use concurrent I/O mode for data. This mode performs direct I/O
8559 and drops the POSIX requirement to serialize all I/O to the same file.
8560 A file cannot be opened in CIO mode and with a standard open at the
8566 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
8567 Note that the kernel may impose restrictions on read or write buffer sizes.
8568 For example, with an ext4 destination file system and a Linux-based kernel,
8569 using @samp{oflag=direct} will cause writes to fail with @code{EINVAL} if the
8570 output buffer size is not a multiple of 512.
8574 @cindex directory I/O
8576 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
8577 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
8581 @cindex synchronized data reads
8582 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
8583 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
8584 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
8585 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
8586 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
8590 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
8591 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
8595 @cindex discarding file cache
8596 Discard the data cache for a file.
8597 When count=0 all cache is discarded,
8598 otherwise the cache is dropped for the processed
8599 portion of the file. Also when count=0
8600 failure to discard the cache is diagnosed
8601 and reflected in the exit status.
8602 Here as some usage examples:
8605 # Advise to drop cache for whole file
8606 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache count=0
8608 # Ensure drop cache for the whole file
8609 dd of=ofile oflag=nocache conv=notrunc,fdatasync count=0
8611 # Drop cache for part of file
8612 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache skip=10 count=10 of=/dev/null
8614 # Stream data using just the read-ahead cache
8615 dd if=ifile of=ofile iflag=nocache oflag=nocache
8620 @cindex nonblocking I/O
8621 Use non-blocking I/O.
8626 Do not update the file's access time.
8627 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
8628 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
8632 @cindex controlling terminal
8633 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
8634 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
8635 On many hosts (e.g., GNU/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
8640 @cindex symbolic links, following
8641 Do not follow symbolic links.
8646 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
8651 Use binary I/O@. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
8652 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
8657 Use text I/O@. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
8662 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
8663 may return early if a full block is not available.
8664 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
8666 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8667 This flag is useful with pipes for example
8668 as they may return short reads. In that case,
8669 this flag is needed to ensure that a @samp{count=} argument is
8670 interpreted as a block count rather than a count of read operations.
8673 @opindex count_bytes
8674 Interpret the @samp{count=} operand as a byte count,
8675 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8676 a length that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8677 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8681 Interpret the @samp{skip=} operand as a byte count,
8682 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8683 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8684 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
8688 Interpret the @samp{seek=} operand as a byte count,
8689 rather than a block count, which allows specifying
8690 an offset that is not a multiple of the I/O block size.
8691 This flag can be used only with @code{oflag}.
8695 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
8696 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
8697 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
8698 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
8699 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
8700 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
8704 @cindex multipliers after numbers
8705 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{n} and @var{bytes})
8706 can be followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
8707 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
8708 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
8710 Any block size you specify via @samp{bs=}, @samp{ibs=}, @samp{obs=}, @samp{cbs=}
8711 should not be too large---values larger than a few megabytes
8712 are generally wasteful or (as in the gigabyte..exabyte case) downright
8713 counterproductive or error-inducing.
8715 To process data that is at an offset or size that is not a
8716 multiple of the I/O@ block size, you can use the @samp{skip_bytes},
8717 @samp{seek_bytes} and @samp{count_bytes} flags. Alternatively
8718 the traditional method of separate @command{dd} invocations can be used.
8719 For example, the following shell commands copy data
8720 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save
8721 or restore a 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
8724 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
8727 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
8728 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
8730 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
8731 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
8735 @cindex disks, failing
8736 For failing disks, other tools come with a great variety of extra
8737 functionality to ease the saving of as much data as possible before the
8738 disk finally dies, e.g.
8739 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/ddrescue/, GNU @command{ddrescue}}.
8740 However, in some cases such a tool is not available or the administrator
8741 feels more comfortable with the handling of @command{dd}.
8742 As a simple rescue method, call @command{dd} as shown in the following
8743 example: the options @samp{conv=noerror,sync} are used to continue
8744 after read errors and to pad out bad reads with NULs, while
8745 @samp{iflag=fullblock} caters for short reads (which traditionally never
8746 occur on disk based devices):
8749 # Rescue data from an (unmounted!) partition of a failing disk.
8750 dd conv=noerror,sync iflag=fullblock </dev/sda1 > /mnt/rescue.img
8753 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal (or @samp{USR1} signal where that is unavailable)
8754 to a running @command{dd} process makes it print I/O statistics to
8755 standard error and then resume copying. In the example below,
8756 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 5GB of data.
8757 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
8758 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
8759 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
8762 # Ignore the signal so we never inadvertently terminate the dd child.
8763 # Note this is not needed when SIGINFO is available.
8766 # Run dd with the fullblock iflag to avoid short reads
8767 # which can be triggered by reception of signals.
8768 dd iflag=fullblock if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=5000000 bs=1000 & pid=$!
8770 # Output stats every half second
8771 until ! kill -s USR1 $pid 2>/dev/null; do sleep .5; done
8774 The above script will output in the following format
8779 4295000000 bytes (4.3 GB) copied, 0.539934 s, 8.0 GB/s
8782 5000000000 bytes (5.0 GB) copied, 0.630785 s, 7.9 GB/s
8785 Note also the @samp{status=progress} option which periodically updates
8786 the last line of the transfer statistics above.
8788 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
8789 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
8790 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
8791 environment variable is set.
8796 @node install invocation
8797 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
8800 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
8802 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
8803 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
8806 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8807 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8808 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8809 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
8814 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
8818 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8819 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8820 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8821 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
8822 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
8825 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
8826 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
8827 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
8828 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
8829 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8830 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
8833 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
8834 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
8835 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
8836 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
8837 files onto themselves.
8839 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
8840 @command{install} never preserves extended attributes (xattr).
8842 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8852 Compare each pair of source and destination files, and if the destination has
8853 identical content and any specified owner, group, permissions, and possibly
8854 SELinux context, then do not modify the destination at all.
8855 Note this option is best used in conjunction with @option{--user},
8856 @option{--group} and @option{--mode} options, lest @command{install}
8857 incorrectly determines the default attributes that installed files would have
8858 (as it doesn't consider setgid directories and POSIX default ACLs for example).
8859 This could result in redundant copies or attributes that are not reset to the
8864 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
8868 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
8869 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
8870 Explicitly specifying the @option{--target-directory=@var{dir}} will similarly
8871 ensure the presence of that hierarchy before copying @var{source} arguments.
8876 @opindex --directory
8877 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
8878 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
8879 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
8880 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
8881 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
8882 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
8884 @item -g @var{group}
8885 @itemx --group=@var{group}
8888 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
8889 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
8890 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
8891 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
8894 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8897 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
8898 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
8899 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
8900 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
8901 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
8902 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
8903 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
8904 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
8905 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
8906 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
8907 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
8909 @item -o @var{owner}
8910 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
8913 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
8914 @cindex appropriate privileges
8915 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
8916 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
8917 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
8918 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
8921 @item --preserve-context
8922 @opindex --preserve-context
8924 @cindex security context
8925 Preserve the SELinux security context of files and directories.
8926 Failure to preserve the context in all of the files or directories
8927 will result in an exit status of 1. If SELinux is disabled then
8928 print a warning and ignore the option.
8931 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
8933 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
8934 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
8935 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
8936 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
8937 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
8938 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
8939 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
8940 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
8941 to when they were last installed.
8947 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
8948 @cindex stripping symbol table information
8949 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
8951 @item --strip-program=@var{program}
8952 @opindex --strip-program
8953 @cindex symbol table information, stripping, program
8954 Program used to strip binaries.
8960 @optNoTargetDirectory
8966 Print the name of each file before copying it.
8969 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve-context} option.
8978 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
8982 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
8985 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8986 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8987 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8992 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
8996 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8997 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8998 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8999 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
9000 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
9003 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
9004 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
9005 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
9006 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
9007 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
9008 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
9009 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
9010 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
9011 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
9012 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
9013 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
9014 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
9017 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
9018 @command{mv} always tries to copy extended attributes (xattr), which may
9019 include SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities.
9020 Upon failure all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
9022 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
9023 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
9024 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
9025 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
9026 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
9027 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9029 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
9030 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
9031 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
9032 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
9033 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with
9034 @code{errno=ENOTDIR}@.
9035 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
9036 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
9037 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
9039 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9049 @cindex prompts, omitting
9050 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
9052 If you specify more than one of the @option{-i}, @option{-f}, @option{-n}
9053 options, only the final one takes effect.
9058 @itemx --interactive
9060 @opindex --interactive
9061 @cindex prompts, forcing
9062 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
9064 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9070 @opindex --no-clobber
9071 @cindex prompts, omitting
9072 Do not overwrite an existing file.
9074 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
9080 @cindex newer files, moving only
9081 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
9082 same or newer modification time.
9083 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
9084 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
9085 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
9086 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
9087 same source and destination.
9093 Print the name of each file before moving it.
9095 @optStripTrailingSlashes
9101 @optNoTargetDirectory
9107 @cindex SELinux, restoring security context
9108 @cindex security context
9109 This option functions similarly to the @command{restorecon} command,
9110 by adjusting the SELinux security context according
9111 to the system default type for destination files.
9119 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
9122 @cindex removing files or directories
9124 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
9125 directories. Synopsis:
9128 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9131 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
9132 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
9133 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
9134 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
9135 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
9136 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
9138 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
9139 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
9140 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
9141 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
9142 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9144 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
9145 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting, as mandated
9148 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
9149 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
9150 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
9152 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9160 @cindex directories, removing
9161 Remove the listed directories if they are empty.
9167 Ignore nonexistent files and missing operands, and never prompt the user.
9168 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
9172 Prompt whether to remove each file.
9173 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
9174 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
9175 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
9179 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
9180 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
9181 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
9182 @option{--interactive=once}.
9184 @item --interactive [=@var{when}]
9185 @opindex --interactive
9186 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
9190 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
9191 - Do not prompt at all.
9193 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
9194 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
9195 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
9197 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
9198 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
9200 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
9201 @option{--interactive=always}.
9203 @item --one-file-system
9204 @opindex --one-file-system
9205 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
9206 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
9207 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
9210 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
9211 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
9212 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
9213 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
9214 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
9215 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
9216 under @file{/home}, too.
9217 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
9218 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
9219 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
9220 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
9222 @item --preserve-root
9223 @opindex --preserve-root
9224 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
9225 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
9226 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
9227 This is the default behavior.
9228 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9230 @item --no-preserve-root
9231 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9232 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
9233 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
9234 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
9235 remove all the files on your computer.
9236 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9243 @opindex --recursive
9244 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
9245 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
9251 Print the name of each file before removing it.
9255 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
9256 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
9257 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
9258 @samp{-}. GNU @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
9259 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
9260 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
9261 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
9274 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
9275 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
9276 predates the development of the @code{getopt} standard syntax.
9281 @node shred invocation
9282 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
9285 @cindex data, erasing
9286 @cindex erasing data
9288 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
9289 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
9291 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
9292 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
9293 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
9294 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
9295 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
9297 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
9298 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
9299 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
9300 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
9302 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
9303 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
9304 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
9305 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
9308 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
9309 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
9310 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
9311 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
9312 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
9314 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
9315 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
9316 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
9317 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
9318 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
9319 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
9320 from the proceedings of the Sixth USENIX Security Symposium (San Jose,
9321 California, July 22--25, 1996).
9323 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
9324 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
9325 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
9326 assumption. Exceptions include:
9331 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
9332 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
9333 BFS, NTFS, etc., when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
9336 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
9337 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
9340 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
9343 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
9347 Compressed file systems.
9350 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
9351 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
9352 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
9353 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
9354 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
9355 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
9356 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
9357 the mount man page (man mount).
9359 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
9360 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
9361 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
9363 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
9364 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
9365 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
9366 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
9367 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
9370 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
9371 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
9372 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
9373 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
9374 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
9377 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
9378 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
9379 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
9380 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
9381 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
9384 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
9387 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9395 @cindex force deletion
9396 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
9398 @item -n @var{number}
9399 @itemx --iterations=@var{number}
9400 @opindex -n @var{number}
9401 @opindex --iterations=@var{number}
9402 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
9403 By default, @command{shred} uses @value{SHRED_DEFAULT_PASSES} passes of
9404 overwrite. You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you think it's
9405 appropriate. After 25 passes all of the internal overwrite patterns will have
9406 been used at least once.
9408 @item --random-source=@var{file}
9409 @opindex --random-source
9410 @cindex random source for shredding
9411 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
9412 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
9414 @item -s @var{bytes}
9415 @itemx --size=@var{bytes}
9416 @opindex -s @var{bytes}
9417 @opindex --size=@var{bytes}
9418 @cindex size of file to shred
9419 Shred the first @var{bytes} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
9420 the whole file. @var{bytes} can be followed by a size specification like
9421 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
9424 @itemx --remove[=@var{how}]
9427 @opindex --remove=unlink
9428 @opindex --remove=wipe
9429 @opindex --remove=wipesync
9430 @cindex removing files after shredding
9431 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
9432 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
9433 Often the file name is less sensitive than the file data, in which case
9434 the optional @var{how} parameter, supported with the long form option,
9435 gives control of how to more efficiently remove each directory entry.
9436 The @samp{unlink} parameter will just use a standard unlink call,
9437 @samp{wipe} will also first obfuscate bytes in the name, and
9438 @samp{wipesync} will also sync each obfuscated byte in the name to disk.
9439 Note @samp{wipesync} is the default method, but can be expensive,
9440 requiring a sync for every character in every file. This can become
9441 significant with many files, or is redundant if your file system provides
9442 synchronous metadata updates.
9448 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
9454 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
9455 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the slack space in
9456 the last block of the file. This space may contain portions of the current
9457 system memory on some systems for example.
9458 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
9459 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
9460 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
9461 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
9467 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
9468 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
9469 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
9470 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
9471 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
9472 by the @option{--iterations} option.
9476 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
9477 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
9478 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
9482 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
9485 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
9486 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
9489 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
9492 On modern disks, a single pass should be adequate,
9493 and it will take one third the time of the default three-pass approach.
9496 # 1 pass, write pseudo-random data; 3x faster than the default
9497 shred --verbose -n1 /dev/sda5
9500 To be on the safe side, use at least one pass that overwrites using
9501 pseudo-random data. I.e., don't be tempted to use @samp{-n0 --zero},
9502 in case some disk controller optimizes the process of writing blocks
9503 of all zeros, and thereby does not clear all bytes in a block.
9504 Some SSDs may do just that.
9506 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
9507 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
9514 echo "Hello, world" >&3
9519 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
9520 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
9521 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
9522 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
9527 @node Special file types
9528 @chapter Special file types
9530 @cindex special file types
9531 @cindex file types, special
9533 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
9534 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
9536 @cindex special file types
9538 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
9539 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
9540 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
9541 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
9542 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
9543 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
9544 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
9545 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
9547 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
9548 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
9551 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9552 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
9553 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
9554 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
9555 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
9556 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name.
9557 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
9558 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
9562 @node link invocation
9563 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
9566 @cindex links, creating
9567 @cindex hard links, creating
9568 @cindex creating links (hard only)
9570 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
9571 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
9572 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
9573 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9574 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
9575 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
9579 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
9582 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
9583 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
9584 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
9587 On a GNU system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
9588 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
9589 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
9590 not specified by POSIX, and the @command{link} command is
9591 more portable in practice.
9593 If @var{filename} is a symbolic link, it is unspecified whether
9594 @var{linkname} will be a hard link to the symbolic link or to the
9595 target of the symbolic link. Use @command{ln -P} or @command{ln -L}
9596 to specify which behavior is desired.
9602 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
9605 @cindex links, creating
9606 @cindex hard links, creating
9607 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
9608 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
9610 @cindex file systems and hard links
9611 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
9612 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
9616 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
9617 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
9618 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
9619 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
9625 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
9626 file from the second.
9629 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
9630 in the current directory.
9633 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
9634 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
9635 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
9636 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
9637 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
9641 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
9642 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
9643 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
9644 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
9647 @cindex hard link, defined
9648 @cindex inode, and hard links
9649 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
9650 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
9651 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
9652 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
9653 file. Most systems prohibit making a hard link to
9654 a directory; on those where it is allowed, only the super-user can do
9655 so (and with caution, since creating a cycle will cause problems to many
9656 other utilities). Hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
9657 restrictions are not mandated by POSIX, however.)
9659 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
9660 @cindex symbolic link, defined
9661 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
9662 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
9663 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
9664 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
9665 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
9666 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
9667 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
9668 link file itself, rather than on its target. The owner and group of a
9669 symlink are not significant to file access performed through
9670 the link, but do have implications on deleting a symbolic link from a
9671 directory with the restricted deletion bit set. On the GNU system,
9672 the mode of a symlink has no significance and cannot be changed, but
9673 on some BSD systems, the mode can be changed and will affect whether
9674 the symlink will be traversed in file name resolution. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
9675 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
9677 Symbolic links can contain arbitrary strings; a @dfn{dangling symlink}
9678 occurs when the string in the symlink does not resolve to a file.
9679 There are no restrictions against creating dangling symbolic links.
9680 There are trade-offs to using absolute or relative symlinks. An
9681 absolute symlink always points to the same file, even if the directory
9682 containing the link is moved. However, if the symlink is visible from
9683 more than one machine (such as on a networked file system), the file
9684 pointed to might not always be the same. A relative symbolic link is
9685 resolved in relation to the directory that contains the link, and is
9686 often useful in referring to files on the same device without regards
9687 to what name that device is mounted on when accessed via networked
9690 When creating a relative symlink in a different location than the
9691 current directory, the resolution of the symlink will be different
9692 than the resolution of the same string from the current directory.
9693 Therefore, many users prefer to first change directories to the
9694 location where the relative symlink will be created, so that
9695 tab-completion or other file resolution will find the same target as
9696 what will be placed in the symlink.
9698 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9709 @opindex --directory
9710 @cindex hard links to directories
9711 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
9713 However, note that this will probably fail due to
9714 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
9720 Remove existing destination files.
9723 @itemx --interactive
9725 @opindex --interactive
9726 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
9727 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
9733 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9734 link, create the hard link to the file referred to by the symbolic
9735 link, rather than the symbolic link itself.
9738 @itemx --no-dereference
9740 @opindex --no-dereference
9741 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
9742 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
9744 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
9745 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
9746 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
9747 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
9748 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
9749 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
9750 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
9751 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
9752 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
9753 just like a directory.
9755 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
9756 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
9762 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
9763 link, create the hard link to the symbolic link itself. On platforms
9764 where this is not supported by the kernel, this option creates a
9765 symbolic link with identical contents; since symbolic link contents
9766 cannot be edited, any file name resolution performed through either
9767 link will be the same as if a hard link had been created.
9773 Make symbolic links relative to the link location.
9778 ln -srv /a/file /tmp
9779 '/tmp/file' -> '../a/file'
9782 Relative symbolic links are generated based on their canonicalized
9783 containing directory, and canonicalized targets. I.e., all symbolic
9784 links in these file names will be resolved.
9785 @xref{realpath invocation}, which gives greater control
9786 over relative file name generation, as demonstrated in the following example:
9791 test "$1" = --no-symlinks && { nosym=$1; shift; }
9793 test -d "$2" && link="$2/." || link="$2"
9794 rtarget="$(realpath $nosym -m "$target" \
9795 --relative-to "$(dirname "$link")")"
9796 ln -s -v "$rtarget" "$link"
9805 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
9806 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
9812 @optNoTargetDirectory
9818 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
9822 @cindex hard links to symbolic links
9823 @cindex symbolic links and @command{ln}
9824 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
9825 precedence. If @option{-s} is also given, @option{-L} and @option{-P}
9826 are silently ignored. If neither option is given, then this
9827 implementation defaults to @option{-P} if the system @code{link} supports
9828 hard links to symbolic links (such as the GNU system), and @option{-L}
9829 if @code{link} follows symbolic links (such as on BSD).
9838 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
9839 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
9844 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
9850 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
9851 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
9855 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
9856 # work across networked file systems.
9857 ln -s afile anotherfile
9858 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
9862 @node mkdir invocation
9863 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
9866 @cindex directories, creating
9867 @cindex creating directories
9869 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
9872 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
9875 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
9876 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
9877 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
9879 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9884 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9887 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
9888 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
9889 which uses the same syntax as
9890 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
9891 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
9893 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
9894 is created. As a GNU extension, @var{mode} may also mention
9895 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
9896 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
9897 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
9898 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
9899 overridden in this way.
9905 @cindex parent directories, creating
9906 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
9907 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
9908 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
9911 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
9912 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
9913 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
9914 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
9915 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
9916 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
9917 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
9918 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
9919 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
9925 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
9935 @node mkfifo invocation
9936 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
9939 @cindex FIFOs, creating
9940 @cindex named pipes, creating
9941 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
9943 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
9944 specified names. Synopsis:
9947 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
9950 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
9951 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
9952 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
9953 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
9955 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9960 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
9963 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
9964 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
9965 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
9966 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
9967 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
9976 @node mknod invocation
9977 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
9980 @cindex block special files, creating
9981 @cindex character special files, creating
9983 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
9984 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
9987 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
9990 @cindex special files
9991 @cindex block special files
9992 @cindex character special files
9993 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
9994 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
9995 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
9996 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
9997 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
9998 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
9999 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
10000 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
10002 @c mknod is a shell built-in at least with OpenBSD's /bin/sh
10003 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{mknod}
10005 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
10010 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
10014 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
10015 for a block special file
10018 @c Don't document the 'u' option -- it's just a synonym for 'c'.
10019 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
10021 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
10022 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
10023 for a character special file
10027 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
10028 device numbers must be given after the file type.
10029 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
10030 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
10031 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
10033 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10037 @item -m @var{mode}
10038 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10041 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
10042 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
10043 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
10044 @xref{File permissions}.
10053 @node readlink invocation
10054 @section @command{readlink}: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
10057 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
10058 @cindex canonical file name
10059 @cindex canonicalize a file name
10062 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
10066 @item Readlink mode
10068 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic links.
10069 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
10070 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
10072 @item Canonicalize mode
10074 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given files which contain
10075 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
10076 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
10081 readlink [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10084 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
10086 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10091 @itemx --canonicalize
10093 @opindex --canonicalize
10094 Activate canonicalize mode.
10095 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
10096 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit
10097 code. A trailing slash is ignored.
10100 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
10102 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
10103 Activate canonicalize mode.
10104 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
10105 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code. A trailing slash
10106 requires that the name resolve to a directory.
10109 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
10111 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
10112 Activate canonicalize mode.
10113 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
10117 @itemx --no-newline
10119 @opindex --no-newline
10120 Do not print the output delimiter, when a single @var{file} is specified.
10121 Print a warning if specified along with multiple @var{file}s.
10131 Suppress most error messages.
10137 Report error messages.
10143 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
10145 The @command{realpath} command without options, operates like
10146 @command{readlink} in canonicalize mode.
10151 @node rmdir invocation
10152 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
10155 @cindex removing empty directories
10156 @cindex directories, removing empty
10158 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
10161 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
10164 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
10165 directory, it is an error.
10167 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10171 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
10172 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
10173 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
10174 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
10175 the directory is non-empty.
10181 @cindex parent directories, removing
10182 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
10183 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
10184 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
10185 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
10186 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
10187 exit unsuccessfully.
10193 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
10194 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
10195 @var{directory} is removed.
10199 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
10204 @node unlink invocation
10205 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
10208 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
10210 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
10211 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
10212 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
10213 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
10214 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
10215 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
10218 unlink @var{filename}
10221 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
10222 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
10223 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
10225 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
10226 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
10227 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
10232 @node Changing file attributes
10233 @chapter Changing file attributes
10235 @cindex changing file attributes
10236 @cindex file attributes, changing
10237 @cindex attributes, file
10239 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
10240 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
10241 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
10242 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
10243 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
10246 These commands change file attributes.
10249 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
10250 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
10251 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
10252 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
10256 @node chown invocation
10257 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
10260 @cindex file ownership, changing
10261 @cindex group ownership, changing
10262 @cindex changing file ownership
10263 @cindex changing group ownership
10265 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
10266 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
10270 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10274 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
10275 (with no embedded white space):
10278 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
10285 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
10286 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
10289 @item owner@samp{:}group
10290 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
10291 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
10292 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
10294 @item owner@samp{:}
10295 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
10296 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
10297 @var{owner}'s login group.
10299 @item @samp{:}group
10300 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
10301 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
10302 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
10305 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
10306 owner nor the group is changed.
10310 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
10311 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
10312 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
10314 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
10315 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
10316 require support for that, but for backward compatibility GNU
10317 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
10318 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
10319 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
10320 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
10323 @macro chownGroupRestrictions
10324 It is system dependent whether a user can change the group to an arbitrary one,
10325 or the more portable behavior of being restricted to setting a group of
10326 which the user is a member.
10328 @chownGroupRestrictions
10330 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
10331 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
10332 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
10333 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
10334 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
10335 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
10336 privileges, or when the
10337 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
10338 mandatory locking).
10339 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
10341 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10349 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
10350 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
10359 @cindex error messages, omitting
10360 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
10363 @item --from=@var{old-owner}
10365 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10366 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
10367 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
10369 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
10370 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
10371 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
10372 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
10375 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
10378 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
10379 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
10380 may be quite large.
10381 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
10385 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
10388 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
10389 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
10390 though still not perfect:
10393 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
10396 @item --dereference
10397 @opindex --dereference
10398 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10400 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10401 This is the default.
10404 @itemx --no-dereference
10406 @opindex --no-dereference
10407 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10409 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10410 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10411 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10412 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
10413 is a symbolic link.
10414 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10415 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10417 @item --preserve-root
10418 @opindex --preserve-root
10419 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10420 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10421 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10422 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10424 @item --no-preserve-root
10425 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10426 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10427 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10428 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10430 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10431 @opindex --reference
10432 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
10433 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10434 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
10441 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10442 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10443 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10444 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10445 its referent is being changed.
10450 @opindex --recursive
10451 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
10452 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
10455 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10458 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10461 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10470 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
10473 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
10474 chown root:staff /u
10476 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
10481 @node chgrp invocation
10482 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
10485 @cindex group ownership, changing
10486 @cindex changing group ownership
10488 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
10489 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
10490 or to the group of an existing reference file. @xref{chown invocation}.
10494 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10498 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
10499 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
10500 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
10502 @chownGroupRestrictions
10504 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10512 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
10513 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
10522 @cindex error messages, omitting
10523 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
10526 @item --dereference
10527 @opindex --dereference
10528 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
10530 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
10531 This is the default.
10534 @itemx --no-dereference
10536 @opindex --no-dereference
10537 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
10539 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
10540 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
10541 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
10542 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
10543 is a symbolic link.
10544 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
10545 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
10547 @item --preserve-root
10548 @opindex --preserve-root
10549 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10550 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10551 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10552 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10554 @item --no-preserve-root
10555 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10556 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10557 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10558 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10560 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10561 @opindex --reference
10562 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
10563 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
10564 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10570 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
10571 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
10572 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
10573 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
10574 its referent is being changed.
10579 @opindex --recursive
10580 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
10581 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
10584 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10587 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10590 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
10599 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
10602 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
10607 @node chmod invocation
10608 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
10611 @cindex changing access permissions
10612 @cindex access permissions, changing
10613 @cindex permissions, changing access
10615 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
10618 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
10622 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
10623 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
10624 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
10625 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
10626 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
10627 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
10628 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
10629 recursive directory traversals.
10631 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
10632 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
10633 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
10634 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
10635 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
10636 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
10637 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
10638 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
10640 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
10641 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
10642 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
10643 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
10644 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
10645 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
10646 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
10648 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10656 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
10665 @cindex error messages, omitting
10666 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
10669 @item --preserve-root
10670 @opindex --preserve-root
10671 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
10672 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
10673 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
10674 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10676 @item --no-preserve-root
10677 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10678 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
10679 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
10680 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10686 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
10688 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
10689 @opindex --reference
10690 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
10691 @xref{File permissions}.
10692 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
10693 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
10698 @opindex --recursive
10699 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
10700 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
10707 @node touch invocation
10708 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
10711 @cindex changing file timestamps
10712 @cindex file timestamps, changing
10713 @cindex timestamps, changing file
10715 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
10716 specified files. Synopsis:
10719 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
10722 @cindex empty files, creating
10723 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty, unless
10724 option @option{--no-create} (@option{-c}) or @option{--no-dereference}
10725 (@option{-h}) was in effect.
10727 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
10728 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
10732 By default, @command{touch} sets file timestamps to the current time.
10733 Because @command{touch} acts on its operands left to right, the
10734 resulting timestamps of earlier and later operands may disagree.
10735 Also, the determination of what time is ``current'' depends on the
10736 platform. Platforms with network file systems often use different
10737 clocks for the operating system and for file systems; because
10738 @command{touch} typically uses file systems' clocks by default, clock
10739 skew can cause the resulting file timestamps to appear to be in a
10740 program's ``future'' or ``past''.
10742 @cindex file timestamp resolution
10743 The @command{touch} command sets the file's timestamp to the greatest
10744 representable value that is not greater than the requested time. This
10745 can differ from the requested time for several reasons. First, the
10746 requested time may have a higher resolution than supported. Second, a
10747 file system may use different resolutions for different types of
10748 times. Third, file timestamps may use a different resolution than
10749 operating system timestamps. Fourth, the operating system primitives
10750 used to update timestamps may employ yet a different resolution. For
10751 example, in theory a file system might use 10-microsecond resolution
10752 for access time and 100-nanosecond resolution for modification time,
10753 and the operating system might use nanosecond resolution for the
10754 current time and microsecond resolution for the primitive that
10755 @command{touch} uses to set a file's timestamp to an arbitrary value.
10757 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
10758 When setting file timestamps to the current time, @command{touch} can
10759 change the timestamps for files that the user does not own but has
10760 write permission for. Otherwise, the user must own the files. Some
10761 older systems have a further restriction: the user must own the files
10762 unless both the access and modification times are being set to the
10765 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
10766 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
10767 a standard third one as well: the inode change time. This is often
10768 referred to as a file's @code{ctime}.
10769 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
10770 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
10771 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
10772 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
10773 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
10774 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
10775 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
10776 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
10777 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
10778 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
10779 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
10780 Some operating systems and file systems support a fourth time: the
10781 birth time, when the file was first created; by definition, this
10782 timestamp never changes.
10785 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
10786 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
10787 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
10788 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10789 You can avoid ambiguities during
10790 daylight saving transitions by using UTC time stamps.
10792 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10797 @itemx --time=atime
10798 @itemx --time=access
10802 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
10803 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
10804 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
10805 Change the access time only.
10810 @opindex --no-create
10811 Do not warn about or create files that do not exist.
10814 @itemx --date=@var{time}
10818 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
10819 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
10820 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
10821 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
10822 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
10823 minutes east of UTC@. @xref{Date input formats}.
10824 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
10825 silently ignore any excess precision here.
10829 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
10830 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
10833 @itemx --no-dereference
10835 @opindex --no-dereference
10836 @cindex symbolic links, changing time
10838 Attempt to change the timestamps of a symbolic link, rather than what
10839 the link refers to. When using this option, empty files are not
10840 created, but option @option{-c} must also be used to avoid warning
10841 about files that do not exist. Not all systems support changing the
10842 timestamps of symlinks, since underlying system support for this
10843 action was not required until POSIX 2008. Also, on some
10844 systems, the mere act of examining a symbolic link changes the access
10845 time, such that only changes to the modification time will persist
10846 long enough to be observable. When coupled with option @option{-r}, a
10847 reference timestamp is taken from a symbolic link rather than the file
10851 @itemx --time=mtime
10852 @itemx --time=modify
10855 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
10856 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
10857 Change the modification time only.
10859 @item -r @var{file}
10860 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
10862 @opindex --reference
10863 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
10864 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
10865 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
10866 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
10867 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
10868 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
10869 If @var{file} is a symbolic link, the reference timestamp is taken
10870 from the target of the symlink, unless @option{-h} was also in effect.
10872 @item -t [[@var{cc}]@var{yy}]@var{mmddhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
10873 @cindex leap seconds
10874 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
10875 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
10876 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{cc}
10877 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
10878 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
10879 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
10880 On the atypical systems that support leap seconds, @var{ss} may be
10885 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
10886 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
10887 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
10888 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
10889 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{mmddhhmm}[@var{yy}]} and this
10890 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{yy}, if
10891 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
10892 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
10893 for the other files instead of as a file name.
10894 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
10895 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
10896 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
10897 behavior depends on this variable.
10898 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
10899 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
10905 @chapter Disk usage
10909 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
10910 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
10911 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
10914 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
10915 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
10916 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
10917 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage.
10918 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
10922 @node df invocation
10923 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
10926 @cindex file system disk usage
10927 @cindex disk usage by file system
10929 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
10930 file systems. Synopsis:
10933 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10936 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
10937 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
10938 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
10940 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
10941 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
10942 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
10944 For bind mounts and without arguments, @command{df} only outputs the statistics
10945 for that device with the shortest mount point name in the list of file systems
10946 (@var{mtab}), i.e., it hides duplicate entries, unless the @option{-a} option is
10949 With the same logic, @command{df} elides a mount entry of a dummy pseudo device
10950 if there is another mount entry of a real block device for that mount point with
10951 the same device number, e.g. the early-boot pseudo file system @samp{rootfs} is
10952 not shown per default when already the real root device has been mounted.
10954 @cindex disk device file
10955 @cindex device file, disk
10956 If an argument @var{file} resolves to a special file containing
10957 a mounted file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that
10958 file system rather than on the file system containing the device node.
10959 GNU @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
10960 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
10961 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system structures.
10963 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10971 @cindex ignore file systems
10972 Include in the listing dummy, duplicate, or inaccessible file systems, which
10973 are omitted by default. Dummy file systems are typically special purpose
10974 pseudo file systems such as @samp{/proc}, with no associated storage.
10975 Duplicate file systems are local or remote file systems that are mounted
10976 at separate locations in the local file hierarchy, or bind mounted locations.
10977 Inaccessible file systems are those which are mounted but subsequently
10978 over-mounted by another file system at that point, or otherwise inaccessible
10979 due to permissions of the mount point etc.
10981 @item -B @var{size}
10982 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
10984 @opindex --block-size
10985 @cindex file system sizes
10986 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
10987 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
10993 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
10999 @cindex inode usage
11000 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
11001 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
11002 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
11006 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
11007 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11008 (@pxref{Block size}).
11009 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
11015 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
11016 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
11021 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
11022 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
11023 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
11024 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
11025 out of date. This is the default.
11028 @itemx --output[=@var{field_list}]
11030 Use the output format defined by @var{field_list}, or print all fields if
11031 @var{field_list} is omitted. In the latter case, the order of the columns
11032 conforms to the order of the field descriptions below.
11034 The use of the @option{--output} together with each of the options @option{-i},
11035 @option{-P}, and @option{-T} is mutually exclusive.
11037 FIELD_LIST is a comma-separated list of columns to be included in @command{df}'s
11038 output and therefore effectively controls the order of output columns.
11039 Each field can thus be used at the place of choice, but yet must only be
11042 Valid field names in the @var{field_list} are:
11045 The source of the mount point, usually a device.
11050 Total number of inodes.
11052 Number of used inodes.
11054 Number of available inodes.
11056 Percentage of @var{iused} divided by @var{itotal}.
11059 Total number of blocks.
11061 Number of used blocks.
11063 Number of available blocks.
11065 Percentage of @var{used} divided by @var{size}.
11068 The file name if specified on the command line.
11073 The fields for block and inodes statistics are affected by the scaling
11074 options like @option{-h} as usual.
11076 The definition of the @var{field_list} can even be split among several
11077 @option{--output} uses.
11081 # Print the TARGET (i.e., the mount point) along with their percentage
11082 # statistic regarding the blocks and the inodes.
11083 df --out=target --output=pcent,ipcent
11085 # Print all available fields.
11091 @itemx --portability
11093 @opindex --portability
11094 @cindex one-line output format
11095 @cindex POSIX output format
11096 @cindex portable output format
11097 @cindex output format, portable
11098 Use the POSIX output format. This is like the default format except
11103 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
11104 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
11105 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
11106 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
11109 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to POSIX.
11112 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
11113 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
11114 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
11115 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
11116 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
11123 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
11124 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
11125 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
11126 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
11127 there are many or very busy file systems.
11131 @cindex grand total of disk size, usage and available space
11132 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
11133 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk size, usage
11134 and available space of all listed devices. If no arguments are specified
11135 df will try harder to elide file systems insignificant to the total
11136 available space, by suppressing duplicate remote file systems.
11138 For the grand total line, @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the
11139 @var{source} column, and @samp{"-"} into the @var{target} column.
11140 If there is no @var{source} column (see @option{--output}), then
11141 @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the @var{target} column,
11144 @item -t @var{fstype}
11145 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
11148 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
11149 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
11150 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
11151 By default, nothing is omitted.
11154 @itemx --print-type
11156 @opindex --print-type
11157 @cindex file system types, printing
11158 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
11159 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
11160 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
11161 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
11166 @cindex NFS file system type
11167 An NFS file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
11168 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
11171 @item ext2@r{, }ext3@r{, }ext4@r{, }xfs@r{, }btrfs@dots{}
11172 @cindex Linux file system types
11173 @cindex local file system types
11174 @opindex ext2 @r{file system type}
11175 @opindex ext3 @r{file system type}
11176 @opindex ext4 @r{file system type}
11177 @opindex xfs @r{file system type}
11178 @opindex btrfs @r{file system type}
11179 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
11180 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
11182 @item iso9660@r{, }cdfs
11183 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
11184 @cindex DVD file system type
11185 @cindex ISO9660 file system type
11186 @opindex iso9660 @r{file system type}
11187 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
11188 A file system on a CD or DVD drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
11189 systems use @samp{iso9660}.
11192 @cindex NTFS file system
11193 @cindex DOS file system
11194 @cindex MS-DOS file system
11195 @cindex MS-Windows file system
11196 @opindex ntfs @r{file system file}
11197 @opindex fat @r{file system file}
11198 File systems used by MS-Windows / MS-DOS.
11202 @item -x @var{fstype}
11203 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
11205 @opindex --exclude-type
11206 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
11207 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
11208 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
11211 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
11215 @command{df} is installed only on systems that have usable mount tables,
11216 so portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
11219 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
11220 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
11221 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
11222 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
11224 Since the list of file systems (@var{mtab}) is needed to determine the
11225 file system type, failure includes the cases when that list cannot
11226 be read and one or more of the options @option{-a}, @option{-l}, @option{-t}
11227 or @option{-x} is used together with a file name argument.
11230 @node du invocation
11231 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
11234 @cindex file space usage
11235 @cindex disk usage for files
11237 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the set of specified files
11238 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
11241 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11244 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
11245 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
11246 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
11247 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
11249 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
11250 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
11251 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
11252 and entries that @command{du} outputs.
11254 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11264 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
11266 @item --apparent-size
11267 @opindex --apparent-size
11268 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
11269 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
11270 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
11271 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
11272 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
11273 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
11274 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
11275 However, a sparse file created with this command:
11278 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
11282 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
11283 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
11285 @item -B @var{size}
11286 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
11288 @opindex --block-size
11290 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
11291 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
11297 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
11303 @cindex grand total of disk space
11304 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
11305 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
11306 a given set of files or directories.
11309 @itemx --dereference-args
11311 @opindex --dereference-args
11312 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
11313 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
11314 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
11315 are often symbolic links.
11317 @item -d @var{depth}
11318 @itemx --max-depth=@var{depth}
11319 @opindex -d @var{depth}
11320 @opindex --max-depth=@var{depth}
11321 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
11322 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
11323 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
11324 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
11326 @c --files0-from=FILE
11327 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
11331 Equivalent to @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
11337 @cindex inode usage, dereferencing in @command{du}
11338 List inode usage information instead of block usage.
11339 This option is useful for finding directories which contain many files, and
11340 therefore eat up most of the inodes space of a file system (see @command{df},
11341 option @option{--inodes}).
11342 It can well be combined with the options @option{-a}, @option{-c},
11343 @option{-h}, @option{-l}, @option{-s}, @option{-S}, @option{-t} and
11344 @option{-x}; however, passing other options regarding the block size, for
11345 example @option{-b}, @option{-m} and @option{--apparent-size}, is ignored.
11349 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
11350 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11351 (@pxref{Block size}).
11352 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
11355 @itemx --dereference
11357 @opindex --dereference
11358 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
11359 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
11360 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
11364 @itemx --count-links
11366 @opindex --count-links
11367 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
11368 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
11373 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
11374 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
11375 (@pxref{Block size}).
11376 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
11379 @itemx --no-dereference
11381 @opindex --no-dereference
11382 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
11383 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
11384 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
11387 @itemx --separate-dirs
11389 @opindex --separate-dirs
11390 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
11391 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
11392 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
11393 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
11394 @var{d}, will exclude the size of any subdirectories.
11401 @opindex --summarize
11402 Display only a total for each argument.
11404 @item -t @var{size}
11405 @itemx --threshold=@var{size}
11407 @opindex --threshold
11408 Exclude entries based on a given @var{size}. The @var{size} refers to used
11409 blocks in normal mode (@pxref{Block size}), or inodes count in conjunction
11410 with the @option{--inodes} option.
11412 If @var{size} is positive, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
11413 greater than or equal to that.
11415 If @var{size} is negative, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
11416 smaller than or equal to that.
11418 Although GNU @command{find} can be used to find files of a certain size,
11419 @command{du}'s @option{--threshold} option can be used to also filter
11420 directories based on a given size.
11422 Please note that the @option{--threshold} option can be combined with the
11423 @option{--apparent-size} option, and in this case would elide entries based on
11426 Please note that the @option{--threshold} option can be combined with the
11427 @option{--inodes} option, and in this case would elide entries based on
11430 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories with a size
11431 greater than or equal to 200 megabytes:
11434 du --threshold=200MB
11437 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories and files -
11438 note the @option{-a} - with an apparent size smaller than or equal to 500 bytes:
11441 du -a -t -500 --apparent-size
11444 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories on the root
11445 file system with more than 20000 inodes used in the directory tree below:
11448 du --inodes -x --threshold=20000 /
11454 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
11455 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
11456 or any of its subdirectories.
11459 @itemx --time=status
11462 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
11463 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
11464 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
11465 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
11466 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
11469 @itemx --time=access
11471 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
11472 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
11473 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
11474 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
11476 @item --time-style=@var{style}
11477 @opindex --time-style
11479 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
11480 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
11481 be one of the following:
11484 @item +@var{format}
11486 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
11487 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
11488 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
11489 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
11490 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
11491 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
11494 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601 date, time, and time zone
11495 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
11496 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
11497 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
11500 List ISO 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
11501 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
11502 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
11503 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
11506 List ISO 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
11507 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
11511 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
11512 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
11513 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
11514 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
11515 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
11516 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
11517 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
11519 @item -X @var{file}
11520 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{file}
11521 @opindex -X @var{file}
11522 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{file}
11523 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
11524 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{file},
11525 one per line. If @var{file} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
11528 @item --exclude=@var{pattern}
11529 @opindex --exclude=@var{pattern}
11530 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
11531 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{pattern}.
11532 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
11536 @itemx --one-file-system
11538 @opindex --one-file-system
11539 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
11540 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
11541 the argument being processed is on.
11545 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
11546 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
11547 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
11548 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
11549 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
11550 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
11555 @node stat invocation
11556 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
11559 @cindex file status
11560 @cindex file system status
11562 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
11565 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11568 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
11569 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
11570 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
11571 also give information about the files the links point to.
11573 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{stat}
11578 @itemx --dereference
11580 @opindex --dereference
11581 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
11582 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
11583 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
11584 by each symbolic link argument.
11585 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
11588 @itemx --file-system
11590 @opindex --file-system
11591 @cindex file systems
11592 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
11593 instead of information about the files themselves.
11594 This option implies the @option{-L} option.
11597 @itemx --format=@var{format}
11599 @opindex --format=@var{format}
11600 @cindex output format
11601 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11602 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
11603 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
11604 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
11606 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
11611 @item --printf=@var{format}
11612 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
11613 @cindex output format
11614 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
11615 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
11616 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
11617 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
11618 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
11619 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
11621 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
11630 @cindex terse output
11631 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
11633 The output of the following commands are identical and the @option{--format}
11634 also identifies the items printed (in fuller form) in the default format.
11635 Note the format string would include another @samp{%C} at the end with an
11636 active SELinux security context.
11638 $ stat --format="%n %s %b %f %u %g %D %i %h %t %T %X %Y %Z %W %o" ...
11642 The same illustrating terse output in @option{--file-system} mode:
11644 $ stat -f --format="%n %i %l %t %s %S %b %f %a %c %d" ...
11645 $ stat -f --terse ...
11649 The valid @var{format} directives for files with @option{--format} and
11650 @option{--printf} are:
11653 @item %a - Access rights in octal
11654 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
11655 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
11656 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
11657 @item %C - The SELinux security context of a file, if available
11658 @item %d - Device number in decimal
11659 @item %D - Device number in hex
11660 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
11661 @item %F - File type
11662 @item %g - Group ID of owner
11663 @item %G - Group name of owner
11664 @item %h - Number of hard links
11665 @item %i - Inode number
11666 @item %m - Mount point (See note below)
11667 @item %n - File name
11668 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
11669 @item %o - Optimal I/O transfer size hint
11670 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
11671 @item %t - Major device type in hex (see below)
11672 @item %T - Minor device type in hex (see below)
11673 @item %u - User ID of owner
11674 @item %U - User name of owner
11675 @item %w - Time of file birth, or @samp{-} if unknown
11676 @item %W - Time of file birth as seconds since Epoch, or @samp{0}
11677 @item %x - Time of last access
11678 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
11679 @item %y - Time of last data modification
11680 @item %Y - Time of last data modification as seconds since Epoch
11681 @item %z - Time of last status change
11682 @item %Z - Time of last status change as seconds since Epoch
11685 The @samp{%t} and @samp{%T} formats operate on the st_rdev member of
11686 the stat(2) structure, and are only defined for character and block
11687 special files. On some systems or file types, st_rdev may be used to
11688 represent other quantities.
11690 The @samp{%W}, @samp{%X}, @samp{%Y}, and @samp{%Z} formats accept a
11691 precision preceded by a period to specify the number of digits to
11692 print after the decimal point. For example, @samp{%.3X} outputs the
11693 last access time to millisecond precision. If a period is given but no
11694 precision, @command{stat} uses 9 digits, so @samp{%.X} is equivalent to
11695 @samp{%.9X}@. When discarding excess precision, time stamps are truncated
11696 toward minus infinity.
11700 $ stat -c '[%015Y]' /usr
11703 $ stat -c '[%15Y]' /usr
11705 $ stat -c '[%-15Y]' /usr
11708 $ stat -c '[%.3Y]' /usr
11710 $ stat -c '[%.Y]' /usr
11711 [1288929712.114951834]
11714 The mount point printed by @samp{%m} is similar to that output
11715 by @command{df}, except that:
11718 stat does not dereference symlinks by default
11719 (unless @option{-L} is specified)
11721 stat does not search for specified device nodes in the
11722 file system list, instead operating on them directly
11725 stat outputs the alias for a bind mounted file, rather than
11726 the initial mount point of its backing device.
11727 One can recursively call stat until there is no change in output,
11728 to get the current base mount point
11731 When listing file system information (@option{--file-system} (@option{-f})),
11732 you must use a different set of @var{format} directives:
11735 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
11736 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
11737 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
11738 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
11739 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
11740 @item %i - File System ID in hex
11741 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
11742 @item %n - File name
11743 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
11744 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
11745 @item %t - Type in hex
11746 @item %T - Type in human readable form
11750 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
11751 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
11752 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
11753 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
11758 @node sync invocation
11759 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
11762 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
11763 @cindex Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
11765 @command{sync} synchronizes in memory files or file systems to persistent
11769 sync [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
11772 @cindex superblock, writing
11773 @cindex inodes, written buffered
11774 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
11775 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
11776 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
11777 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync},
11778 @code{syncfs}, @code{fsync}, and @code{fdatasync} system calls.
11780 @cindex crashes and corruption
11781 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
11782 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
11783 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
11784 result. The @command{sync} command instructs the kernel to write
11785 data in memory to persistent storage.
11787 If any argument is specified then only those files will be
11788 synchronized using the fsync(2) syscall by default.
11790 If at least one file is specified, it is possible to change the
11791 synchronization method with the following options. Also see
11792 @ref{Common options}.
11798 Use fdatasync(2) to sync only the data for the file,
11799 and any metadata required to maintain file system consistency.
11802 @itemx --file-system
11803 @opindex --file-system
11804 Synchronize all the I/O waiting for the file systems that contain the file,
11805 using the syscall syncfs(2). Note you would usually @emph{not} specify
11806 this option if passing a device node like @samp{/dev/sda} for example,
11807 as that would sync the containing file system rather than the referenced one.
11808 Note also that depending on the system, passing individual device nodes or files
11809 may have different sync characteristics than using no arguments.
11810 I.e., arguments passed to fsync(2) may provide greater guarantees through
11811 write barriers, than a global sync(2) used when no arguments are provided.
11817 @node truncate invocation
11818 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
11821 @cindex truncating, file sizes
11823 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
11824 specified size. Synopsis:
11827 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
11830 @cindex files, creating
11831 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
11833 @cindex sparse files, creating
11834 @cindex holes, creating files with
11835 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
11836 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the extended part (or hole)
11837 reads as zero bytes.
11839 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11846 @opindex --no-create
11847 Do not create files that do not exist.
11852 @opindex --io-blocks
11853 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{file} rather than bytes.
11855 @item -r @var{rfile}
11856 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
11858 @opindex --reference
11859 Base the size of each @var{file} on the size of @var{rfile}.
11861 @item -s @var{size}
11862 @itemx --size=@var{size}
11865 Set or adjust the size of each @var{file} according to @var{size}.
11866 @var{size} is in bytes unless @option{--io-blocks} is specified.
11867 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
11869 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
11870 the size of each @var{file} based on its current size:
11872 @samp{+} => extend by
11873 @samp{-} => reduce by
11874 @samp{<} => at most
11875 @samp{>} => at least
11876 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
11877 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
11885 @node Printing text
11886 @chapter Printing text
11888 @cindex printing text, commands for
11889 @cindex commands for printing text
11891 This section describes commands that display text strings.
11894 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
11895 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
11896 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
11900 @node echo invocation
11901 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
11904 @cindex displaying text
11905 @cindex printing text
11906 @cindex text, displaying
11907 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
11909 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
11910 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
11913 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
11916 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{echo}
11918 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11919 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
11920 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
11926 Do not output the trailing newline.
11930 @cindex backslash escapes
11931 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
11940 produce no further output
11956 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
11957 (zero to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
11958 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
11960 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
11961 (one to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
11962 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
11964 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
11965 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
11970 @cindex backslash escapes
11971 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
11972 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
11973 specified, the last one given takes effect.
11977 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
11978 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
11979 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
11980 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
11981 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
11982 plain @samp{hello}.
11984 POSIX does not require support for any options, and says
11985 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
11986 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
11987 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
11988 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
11989 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
11994 @node printf invocation
11995 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
11998 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
12001 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
12004 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
12005 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
12006 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
12007 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
12008 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
12009 The differences are listed below.
12011 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{printf}
12016 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
12017 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
12021 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
12022 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
12023 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
12027 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
12028 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
12029 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
12032 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
12033 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
12034 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
12035 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
12040 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
12041 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
12042 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
12043 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits. If
12044 @samp{\@var{ooo}} is nine-bit value, ignore the ninth bit.
12045 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
12046 from the converted string.
12049 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
12050 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
12054 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
12055 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
12056 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
12057 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
12058 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
12059 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
12060 @samp{97} on hosts that use the ASCII character set, since
12061 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in ASCII.
12066 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
12067 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
12068 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
12069 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
12070 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
12071 @xref{Floating point}.
12075 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
12076 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a byte to print,
12077 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
12078 digits) specifying a character to print.
12079 Note however that when @samp{\@var{ooo}} specifies a number larger than 255,
12080 @command{printf} ignores the ninth bit.
12081 For example, @samp{printf '\400'} is equivalent to @samp{printf '\0'}.
12086 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
12088 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
12090 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (ISO/IEC 10646)
12091 characters, specified as
12092 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
12093 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
12094 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
12095 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the ranges
12096 U+0000@dots{}U+009F, U+D800@dots{}U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax,
12097 except for U+0024 ($), U+0040 (@@), and U+0060 (@`).
12099 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
12100 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
12101 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
12102 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
12104 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
12105 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
12106 Options must precede operands.
12108 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
12109 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
12112 $ env printf '\u20AC 14.95'
12116 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
12117 (ISO-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
12120 $ env printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
12124 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
12126 Note that in these examples, the @command{printf} command has been
12127 invoked via @command{env} to ensure that we run the program found via
12128 your shell's search path, and not a shell alias or a built-in function.
12130 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
12131 values of each character one by one. ASCII characters mixed with \u
12132 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
12133 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
12134 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
12135 this text in a locale-independent way:
12138 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
12139 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
12140 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
12141 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
12148 @node yes invocation
12149 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
12152 @cindex repeated output of a string
12154 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
12155 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
12156 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
12158 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
12160 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12161 To output an argument that begins with
12162 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
12163 @xref{Common options}.
12167 @chapter Conditions
12170 @cindex commands for exit status
12171 @cindex exit status commands
12173 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
12174 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
12175 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
12179 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
12180 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
12181 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
12182 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
12186 @node false invocation
12187 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
12190 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
12191 @cindex failure exit status
12192 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
12194 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
12195 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
12196 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
12197 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
12198 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
12199 command, not the one documented here.
12201 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
12203 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
12204 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
12205 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
12207 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
12208 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
12209 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
12211 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
12212 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
12216 @node true invocation
12217 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
12220 @cindex do nothing, successfully
12222 @cindex successful exit
12223 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
12225 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
12226 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
12227 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
12228 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
12229 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
12230 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
12231 command, not the one documented here.
12233 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
12235 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
12236 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
12237 option, and with standard
12238 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
12239 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
12242 $ ./true --version >&-
12243 ./true: write error: Bad file number
12244 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
12245 ./true: write error: No space left on device
12248 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
12249 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
12250 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
12252 @node test invocation
12253 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
12256 @cindex check file types
12257 @cindex compare values
12258 @cindex expression evaluation
12260 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
12261 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
12262 expression must be a separate argument.
12264 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
12265 comparison operators.
12267 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
12268 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
12269 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
12270 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
12271 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
12272 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
12278 test @var{expression}
12280 [ @var{expression} ]
12285 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{test}
12287 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
12288 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
12289 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true
12290 otherwise. The argument
12291 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
12292 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
12293 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
12294 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
12295 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
12297 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
12301 0 if the expression is true,
12302 1 if the expression is false,
12303 2 if an error occurred.
12307 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
12308 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
12309 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
12310 * String tests:: -z -n = == !=
12311 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
12312 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
12316 @node File type tests
12317 @subsection File type tests
12319 @cindex file type tests
12321 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
12322 but not all files are the same!)
12326 @item -b @var{file}
12328 @cindex block special check
12329 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
12331 @item -c @var{file}
12333 @cindex character special check
12334 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
12336 @item -d @var{file}
12338 @cindex directory check
12339 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
12341 @item -f @var{file}
12343 @cindex regular file check
12344 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
12346 @item -h @var{file}
12347 @itemx -L @var{file}
12350 @cindex symbolic link check
12351 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
12352 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
12353 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
12355 @item -p @var{file}
12357 @cindex named pipe check
12358 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
12360 @item -S @var{file}
12362 @cindex socket check
12363 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
12367 @cindex terminal check
12368 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
12374 @node Access permission tests
12375 @subsection Access permission tests
12377 @cindex access permission tests
12378 @cindex permission tests
12380 These options test for particular access permissions.
12384 @item -g @var{file}
12386 @cindex set-group-ID check
12387 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
12389 @item -k @var{file}
12391 @cindex sticky bit check
12392 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
12394 @item -r @var{file}
12396 @cindex readable file check
12397 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
12399 @item -u @var{file}
12401 @cindex set-user-ID check
12402 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
12404 @item -w @var{file}
12406 @cindex writable file check
12407 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
12409 @item -x @var{file}
12411 @cindex executable file check
12412 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
12413 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
12415 @item -O @var{file}
12417 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
12418 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
12420 @item -G @var{file}
12422 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
12423 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
12427 @node File characteristic tests
12428 @subsection File characteristic tests
12430 @cindex file characteristic tests
12432 These options test other file characteristics.
12436 @item -e @var{file}
12438 @cindex existence-of-file check
12439 True if @var{file} exists.
12441 @item -s @var{file}
12443 @cindex nonempty file check
12444 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
12446 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
12448 @cindex newer-than file check
12449 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
12450 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
12452 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
12454 @cindex older-than file check
12455 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
12456 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
12458 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
12460 @cindex same file check
12461 @cindex hard link check
12462 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
12463 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
12469 @subsection String tests
12471 @cindex string tests
12473 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
12474 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
12480 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
12481 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
12485 @item -z @var{string}
12487 @cindex zero-length string check
12488 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
12490 @item -n @var{string}
12491 @itemx @var{string}
12493 @cindex nonzero-length string check
12494 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
12496 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
12498 @cindex equal string check
12499 True if the strings are equal.
12501 @item @var{string1} == @var{string2}
12503 @cindex equal string check
12504 True if the strings are equal (synonym for =).
12506 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
12508 @cindex not-equal string check
12509 True if the strings are not equal.
12514 @node Numeric tests
12515 @subsection Numeric tests
12517 @cindex numeric tests
12518 @cindex arithmetic tests
12520 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
12521 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
12522 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
12526 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
12527 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
12528 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
12529 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
12530 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
12531 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
12538 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
12539 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
12540 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
12547 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
12549 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
12552 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
12556 @node Connectives for test
12557 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
12559 @cindex logical connectives
12560 @cindex connectives, logical
12562 The usual logical connectives.
12568 True if @var{expr} is false.
12570 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
12572 @cindex logical and operator
12573 @cindex and operator
12574 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
12576 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
12578 @cindex logical or operator
12579 @cindex or operator
12580 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
12585 @node expr invocation
12586 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
12589 @cindex expression evaluation
12590 @cindex evaluation of expressions
12592 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
12593 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
12595 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
12596 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
12597 @command{expr} converts
12598 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
12599 depending on the operation being applied to it.
12601 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
12602 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
12603 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
12604 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
12605 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
12606 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
12607 work around this is to use the GNU extension @code{+},
12608 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
12609 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
12610 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
12612 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
12613 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
12614 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
12615 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
12616 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
12617 leading spaces as mentioned above.
12619 @cindex parentheses for grouping
12620 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
12621 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
12622 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
12625 When built with support for the GNU MP library, @command{expr} uses
12626 arbitrary-precision arithmetic; otherwise, it uses native arithmetic
12627 types and may fail due to arithmetic overflow.
12629 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12630 options}. Options must precede operands.
12632 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
12636 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
12637 1 if the expression is null or 0,
12638 2 if the expression is invalid,
12639 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
12643 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
12644 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
12645 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
12646 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
12650 @node String expressions
12651 @subsection String expressions
12653 @cindex string expressions
12654 @cindex expressions, string
12656 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
12657 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
12658 the next sections).
12662 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
12663 @cindex pattern matching
12664 @cindex regular expression matching
12665 @cindex matching patterns
12666 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
12667 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
12668 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
12669 then matched against this regular expression.
12671 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
12672 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
12673 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
12675 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
12676 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
12678 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
12679 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
12680 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
12681 expression operators.
12683 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
12684 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
12685 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
12686 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
12687 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
12688 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
12689 characters. (POSIX allows either behavior.)
12690 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
12691 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
12693 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
12695 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
12696 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
12698 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
12700 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
12701 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
12702 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
12704 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
12706 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
12707 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
12708 @var{string}, return 0.
12710 @item length @var{string}
12712 Returns the length of @var{string}.
12714 @item + @var{token}
12716 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
12717 or an operator like @code{/}.
12718 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
12719 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
12720 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
12721 This operator is a GNU extension. Portable shell scripts should use
12722 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
12726 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
12727 @code{quote} operator.
12730 @node Numeric expressions
12731 @subsection Numeric expressions
12733 @cindex numeric expressions
12734 @cindex expressions, numeric
12736 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
12737 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
12738 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
12739 than the connectives (next section).
12747 @cindex subtraction
12748 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
12749 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12755 @cindex multiplication
12758 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
12759 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
12764 @node Relations for expr
12765 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
12767 @cindex connectives, logical
12768 @cindex logical connectives
12769 @cindex relations, numeric or string
12771 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
12772 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
12773 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
12779 @cindex logical or operator
12780 @cindex or operator
12781 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
12782 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
12783 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
12788 @cindex logical and operator
12789 @cindex and operator
12790 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
12791 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
12794 @item < <= = == != >= >
12801 @cindex comparison operators
12803 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
12804 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
12805 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
12806 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
12807 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
12812 @node Examples of expr
12813 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
12815 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
12816 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
12818 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
12821 foo=$(expr $foo + 1)
12824 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
12825 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
12828 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
12831 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
12839 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
12841 expr index abcdef cz
12844 @error{} expr: syntax error
12845 expr index + index a
12851 @chapter Redirection
12853 @cindex redirection
12854 @cindex commands for redirection
12856 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
12857 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
12858 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
12859 it's described here.
12862 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
12866 @node tee invocation
12867 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
12870 @cindex pipe fitting
12871 @cindex destinations, multiple output
12872 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
12874 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
12875 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
12876 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
12879 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12882 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
12883 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
12884 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
12886 In previous versions of GNU coreutils (v5.3.0 - v8.23), a @var{file} of @samp{-}
12887 caused @command{tee} to send another copy of input to standard output.
12888 However, as the interleaved output was not very useful, @command{tee} now
12889 conforms to POSIX which explicitly mandates it to treat @samp{-} as a file
12892 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12899 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
12903 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
12905 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
12906 Ignore interrupt signals.
12909 @itemx --output-error[=@var{mode}]
12911 @opindex --output-error
12912 Adjust the behavior with errors on the outputs,
12913 with the long form option supporting selection
12914 between the following @var{mode}s:
12918 Warn on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
12919 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
12920 Exit status indicates failure if any output has an error.
12923 This is the default @var{mode} when not specified,
12924 or when the short form @option{-p} is used.
12925 Warn on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
12926 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
12927 Exit status indicates failure if any non pipe output had an error.
12930 Exit on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
12933 Exit on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
12938 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
12939 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
12940 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
12941 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
12942 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
12945 wget http://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
12948 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
12949 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
12950 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
12951 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
12953 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
12954 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
12955 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
12958 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
12959 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12960 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
12963 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
12964 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
12965 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
12967 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
12968 called @dfn{process substitution}
12969 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
12970 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bash,
12971 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
12972 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
12973 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
12974 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
12976 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
12977 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
12980 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12981 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
12984 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
12985 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
12986 process substitution is required:
12989 wget -O - http://example.com/dvd.iso \
12990 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
12991 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
12995 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
12996 copy of the contents of a pipe.
12997 Consider a tool to graphically summarize disk usage data from @samp{du -ak}.
12998 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
12999 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
13000 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
13001 the uncompressed output.
13003 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
13004 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
13007 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
13008 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | xdiskusage -a
13011 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
13012 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
13015 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | xdiskusage -a
13018 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
13019 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
13020 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
13021 there may be a better way.
13022 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
13023 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
13024 (slightly simplified):
13027 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
13028 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
13029 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
13032 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
13033 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
13034 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
13035 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
13038 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
13039 tar chof - "$tardir" \
13040 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
13041 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
13047 @node File name manipulation
13048 @chapter File name manipulation
13050 @cindex file name manipulation
13051 @cindex manipulation of file names
13052 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
13054 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
13057 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
13058 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component.
13059 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability.
13060 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory.
13061 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names.
13065 @node basename invocation
13066 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
13069 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
13070 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
13071 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
13072 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
13073 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
13075 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
13076 @var{name}. Synopsis:
13079 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
13080 basename @var{option}@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
13083 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
13084 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
13085 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
13086 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
13089 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
13090 @macro basenameAndDirname
13091 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
13092 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
13093 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
13094 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
13096 @basenameAndDirname
13098 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
13099 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, GNU
13100 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
13101 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
13102 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
13104 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13105 Options must precede operands.
13112 @opindex --multiple
13113 Support more than one argument. Treat every argument as a @var{name}.
13114 With this, an optional @var{suffix} must be specified using the
13115 @option{-s} option.
13117 @item -s @var{suffix}
13118 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
13121 Remove a trailing @var{suffix}.
13122 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
13134 basename /usr/bin/sort
13137 basename include/stdio.h .h
13140 basename -s .h include/stdio.h
13142 # Output "stdio" followed by "stdlib"
13143 basename -a -s .h include/stdio.h include/stdlib.h
13147 @node dirname invocation
13148 @section @command{dirname}: Strip last file name component
13151 @cindex directory components, printing
13152 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
13153 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
13155 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component
13156 of each @var{name}. Slashes on either side of the final component are
13157 also removed. If the string contains no slash, @command{dirname}
13158 prints @samp{.} (meaning the current directory). Synopsis:
13161 dirname [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
13164 @var{name} need not be a file name, but if it is, this operation
13165 effectively lists the directory that contains the final component,
13166 including the case when the final component is itself a directory.
13168 @basenameAndDirname
13170 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
13171 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With GNU @command{dirname}, the
13172 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
13173 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
13175 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13188 # Output "/usr/bin".
13189 dirname /usr/bin/sort
13190 dirname /usr/bin//.//
13192 # Output "dir1" followed by "dir2"
13193 dirname dir1/str dir2/str
13200 @node pathchk invocation
13201 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name validity and portability
13204 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
13205 @cindex valid file names, checking for
13206 @cindex portable file names, checking for
13208 @command{pathchk} checks validity and portability of file names. Synopsis:
13211 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
13214 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints an error message if any of
13215 these conditions is true:
13219 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
13220 (execute) permission,
13222 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
13225 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
13226 its file system's maximum.
13229 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
13230 name could be created under the above conditions.
13232 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13233 Options must precede operands.
13239 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
13240 print an error message if any of these conditions is true:
13244 A file name is empty.
13247 A file name contains a character outside the POSIX portable file
13248 name character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{.},
13249 @samp{_}, @samp{-}, and @samp{/}.
13252 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
13253 POSIX minimum limits for portability.
13258 Print an error message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
13259 that begins with @samp{-}.
13261 @item --portability
13262 @opindex --portability
13263 Print an error message if a file name is not portable to all POSIX
13264 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
13268 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
13272 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
13276 @node mktemp invocation
13277 @section @command{mktemp}: Create temporary file or directory
13280 @cindex file names, creating temporary
13281 @cindex directory, creating temporary
13282 @cindex temporary files and directories
13284 @command{mktemp} manages the creation of temporary files and
13285 directories. Synopsis:
13288 mktemp [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{template}]
13291 Safely create a temporary file or directory based on @var{template},
13292 and print its name. If given, @var{template} must include at least
13293 three consecutive @samp{X}s in the last component. If omitted, the template
13294 @samp{tmp.XXXXXXXXXX} is used, and option @option{--tmpdir} is
13295 implied. The final run of @samp{X}s in the @var{template} will be replaced
13296 by alpha-numeric characters; thus, on a case-sensitive file system,
13297 and with a @var{template} including a run of @var{n} instances of @samp{X},
13298 there are @samp{62**@var{n}} potential file names.
13300 Older scripts used to create temporary files by simply joining the
13301 name of the program with the process id (@samp{$$}) as a suffix.
13302 However, that naming scheme is easily predictable, and suffers from a
13303 race condition where the attacker can create an appropriately named
13304 symbolic link, such that when the script then opens a handle to what
13305 it thought was an unused file, it is instead modifying an existing
13306 file. Using the same scheme to create a directory is slightly safer,
13307 since the @command{mkdir} will fail if the target already exists, but
13308 it is still inferior because it allows for denial of service attacks.
13309 Therefore, modern scripts should use the @command{mktemp} command to
13310 guarantee that the generated name will be unpredictable, and that
13311 knowledge of the temporary file name implies that the file was created
13312 by the current script and cannot be modified by other users.
13314 When creating a file, the resulting file has read and write
13315 permissions for the current user, but no permissions for the group or
13316 others; these permissions are reduced if the current umask is more
13319 Here are some examples (although note that if you repeat them, you
13320 will most likely get different file names):
13325 Create a temporary file in the current directory.
13332 Create a temporary file with a known suffix.
13334 $ mktemp --suffix=.txt file-XXXX
13336 $ mktemp file-XXXX-XXXX.txt
13341 Create a secure fifo relative to the user's choice of @env{TMPDIR},
13342 but falling back to the current directory rather than @file{/tmp}.
13343 Note that @command{mktemp} does not create fifos, but can create a
13344 secure directory in which the fifo can live. Exit the shell if the
13345 directory or fifo could not be created.
13347 $ dir=$(mktemp -p "$@{TMPDIR:-.@}" -d dir-XXXX) || exit 1
13349 $ mkfifo "$fifo" || @{ rmdir "$dir"; exit 1; @}
13353 Create and use a temporary file if possible, but ignore failure. The
13354 file will reside in the directory named by @env{TMPDIR}, if specified,
13355 or else in @file{/tmp}.
13357 $ file=$(mktemp -q) && @{
13358 > # Safe to use $file only within this block. Use quotes,
13359 > # since $TMPDIR, and thus $file, may contain whitespace.
13360 > echo ... > "$file"
13366 Act as a semi-random character generator (it is not fully random,
13367 since it is impacted by the contents of the current directory). To
13368 avoid security holes, do not use the resulting names to create a file.
13378 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13385 @opindex --directory
13386 Create a directory rather than a file. The directory will have read,
13387 write, and search permissions for the current user, but no permissions
13388 for the group or others; these permissions are reduced if the current
13389 umask is more restrictive.
13395 Suppress diagnostics about failure to create a file or directory. The
13396 exit status will still reflect whether a file was created.
13402 Generate a temporary name that does not name an existing file, without
13403 changing the file system contents. Using the output of this command
13404 to create a new file is inherently unsafe, as there is a window of
13405 time between generating the name and using it where another process
13406 can create an object by the same name.
13409 @itemx --tmpdir[=@var{dir}]
13412 Treat @var{template} relative to the directory @var{dir}. If
13413 @var{dir} is not specified (only possible with the long option
13414 @option{--tmpdir}) or is the empty string, use the value of
13415 @env{TMPDIR} if available, otherwise use @samp{/tmp}. If this is
13416 specified, @var{template} must not be absolute. However,
13417 @var{template} can still contain slashes, although intermediate
13418 directories must already exist.
13420 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
13422 Append @var{suffix} to the @var{template}. @var{suffix} must not
13423 contain slash. If @option{--suffix} is specified, @var{template} must
13424 end in @samp{X}; if it is not specified, then an appropriate
13425 @option{--suffix} is inferred by finding the last @samp{X} in
13426 @var{template}. This option exists for use with the default
13427 @var{template} and for the creation of a @var{suffix} that starts with
13432 Treat @var{template} as a single file relative to the value of
13433 @env{TMPDIR} if available, or to the directory specified by
13434 @option{-p}, otherwise to @samp{/tmp}. @var{template} must not
13435 contain slashes. This option is deprecated; the use of @option{-p}
13436 without @option{-t} offers better defaults (by favoring the command
13437 line over @env{TMPDIR}) and more flexibility (by allowing intermediate
13442 @cindex exit status of @command{mktemp}
13446 0 if the file was created,
13451 @node realpath invocation
13452 @section @command{realpath}: Print the resolved file name.
13455 @cindex file names, canonicalization
13456 @cindex symlinks, resolution
13457 @cindex canonical file name
13458 @cindex canonicalize a file name
13462 @command{realpath} expands all symbolic links and resolves references to
13463 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and extra @samp{/} characters. By default,
13464 all but the last component of the specified files must exist. Synopsis:
13467 realpath [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
13470 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13475 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
13477 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
13478 Ensure that all components of the specified file names exist.
13479 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{realpath} will output
13480 a diagnostic unless the @option{-q} option is specified, and exit with a
13481 nonzero exit code. A trailing slash requires that the name resolve to a
13485 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
13487 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
13488 If any component of a specified file name is missing or unavailable,
13489 treat it as a directory.
13495 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
13496 but they are resolved after any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
13501 @opindex --physical
13502 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
13503 and they are resolved before any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
13504 This is the default mode of operation.
13510 Suppress diagnostic messages for specified file names.
13512 @item --relative-to=@var{file}
13513 @opindex --relative-to
13515 Print the resolved file names relative to the specified file.
13516 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
13517 pertaining to file existence.
13519 @item --relative-base=@var{base}
13520 @opindex --relative-base
13521 This option is valid when used with @option{--relative-to}, and will restrict
13522 the output of @option{--relative-to} so that relative names are output,
13523 only when @var{file}s are descendants of @var{base}. Otherwise output the
13524 absolute file name. If @option{--relative-to} was not specified, then
13525 the descendants of @var{base} are printed relative to @var{base}. If
13526 @option{--relative-to} is specified, then that directory must be a
13527 descendant of @var{base} for this option to have an effect.
13528 Note: this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e}
13529 options pertaining to file existence. For example:
13532 realpath --relative-to=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
13535 realpath --relative-base=/usr /tmp /usr/bin
13542 @itemx --no-symlinks
13545 @opindex --no-symlinks
13546 Do not resolve symbolic links. Only resolve references to
13547 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and remove extra @samp{/} characters.
13548 When combined with the @option{-m} option, realpath operates
13549 only on the file name, and does not touch any actual file.
13555 @cindex exit status of @command{realpath}
13559 0 if all file names were printed without issue.
13564 @node Working context
13565 @chapter Working context
13567 @cindex working context
13568 @cindex commands for printing the working context
13570 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
13571 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
13572 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
13575 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
13576 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
13577 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
13578 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
13582 @node pwd invocation
13583 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
13586 @cindex print name of current directory
13587 @cindex current working directory, printing
13588 @cindex working directory, printing
13591 @command{pwd} prints the name of the current directory. Synopsis:
13594 pwd [@var{option}]@dots{}
13597 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13604 If the contents of the environment variable @env{PWD} provide an
13605 absolute name of the current directory with no @samp{.} or @samp{..}
13606 components, but possibly with symbolic links, then output those
13607 contents. Otherwise, fall back to default @option{-P} handling.
13612 @opindex --physical
13613 Print a fully resolved name for the current directory. That is, all
13614 components of the printed name will be actual directory names---none
13615 will be symbolic links.
13618 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
13619 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
13620 precedence. If neither option is given, then this implementation uses
13621 @option{-P} as the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
13622 environment variable is set.
13624 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{pwd}
13629 @node stty invocation
13630 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
13633 @cindex change or print terminal settings
13634 @cindex terminal settings
13635 @cindex line settings of terminal
13637 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
13641 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
13642 stty [@var{option}]
13645 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
13646 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
13647 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
13648 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
13649 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
13650 @option{--file} option.
13652 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
13653 the terminal line operation, as described below.
13655 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13662 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
13663 be used in combination with any line settings.
13665 @item -F @var{device}
13666 @itemx --file=@var{device}
13669 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
13670 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
13671 because opening a POSIX tty requires use of the
13672 @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to prevent a POSIX tty from blocking
13673 until the carrier detect line is high if
13674 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
13675 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
13681 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
13682 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
13683 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
13684 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
13688 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
13689 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
13690 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
13691 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
13694 Some settings are not available on all POSIX systems, since they use
13695 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with
13696 ``Non-POSIX'' in their description. On non-POSIX
13697 systems, those or other settings also may not
13698 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
13701 @command{stty} is installed only on platforms with the POSIX terminal
13702 interface, so portable scripts should not rely on its existence on
13703 non-POSIX platforms.
13708 * Control:: Control settings
13709 * Input:: Input settings
13710 * Output:: Output settings
13711 * Local:: Local settings
13712 * Combination:: Combination settings
13713 * Characters:: Special characters
13714 * Special:: Special settings
13719 @subsection Control settings
13721 @cindex control settings
13727 @cindex two-way parity
13728 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
13734 @cindex even parity
13735 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
13739 @cindex constant parity
13740 @cindex stick parity
13741 @cindex mark parity
13742 @cindex space parity
13743 Use "stick" (mark/space) parity. If parodd is set, the parity bit is
13744 always 1; if parodd is not set, the parity bit is always zero.
13745 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13752 @cindex character size
13753 @cindex eight-bit characters
13754 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
13759 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
13765 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
13769 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
13773 @cindex modem control
13774 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
13778 @cindex hardware flow control
13779 @cindex flow control, hardware
13780 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
13781 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13785 @cindex hardware flow control
13786 @cindex flow control, hardware
13787 @cindex DTR/DSR flow control
13788 Enable DTR/DSR flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13793 @subsection Input settings
13795 @cindex input settings
13796 These settings control operations on data received from the terminal.
13801 @cindex breaks, ignoring
13802 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
13806 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
13807 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
13811 @cindex parity, ignoring
13812 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
13816 @cindex parity errors, marking
13817 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
13821 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
13825 @cindex eight-bit input
13826 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
13830 @cindex newline, translating to return
13831 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
13835 @cindex return, ignoring
13836 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
13840 @cindex return, translating to newline
13841 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
13845 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
13846 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
13850 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
13851 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
13852 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{Ctrl-S}/@kbd{Ctrl-Q}). May
13859 @cindex software flow control
13860 @cindex flow control, software
13861 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
13862 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
13863 empty again. May be negated.
13867 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
13868 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
13869 negated. Note ilcuc is not implemented, as one would not be able to issue
13870 almost any (lowercase) Unix command, after invoking it.
13874 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
13875 if negated). Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13879 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
13880 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
13881 when the input buffer is full. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13886 @subsection Output settings
13888 @cindex output settings
13889 These settings control operations on data sent to the terminal.
13894 Postprocess output. May be negated.
13898 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
13899 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
13900 negated. (Note ouclc is not currently implemented.)
13904 @cindex return, translating to newline
13905 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13909 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
13910 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-POSIX@. May be
13915 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-POSIX@.
13920 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
13924 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
13925 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays.
13931 @cindex pad character
13932 Use ASCII DEL characters for fill instead of
13933 ASCII NUL characters. Non-POSIX@.
13939 Newline delay style. Non-POSIX.
13946 Carriage return delay style. Non-POSIX.
13952 @opindex tab@var{n}
13953 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
13958 Backspace delay style. Non-POSIX.
13963 Vertical tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
13968 Form feed delay style. Non-POSIX.
13973 @subsection Local settings
13975 @cindex local settings
13980 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
13981 characters. May be negated.
13985 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
13986 special characters. May be negated.
13990 Enable non-POSIX special characters. May be negated.
13994 Echo input characters. May be negated.
14000 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
14005 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
14006 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
14010 @cindex newline, echoing
14011 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
14015 @cindex flushing, disabling
14016 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
14017 characters. May be negated.
14021 @cindex case translation
14022 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
14023 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
14024 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14028 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
14029 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-POSIX@.
14036 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
14037 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14043 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
14044 @cindex hat notation for control characters
14045 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
14046 of literally. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14052 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
14053 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
14054 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings.
14060 Enable @samp{LINEMODE}, which is used to avoid echoing
14061 each character over high latency links. See also
14062 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc1116.txt, Internet RFC 1116}.
14069 @subsection Combination settings
14071 @cindex combination settings
14072 Combination settings:
14079 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
14080 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
14084 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
14085 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
14089 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
14090 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
14094 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
14101 @c This is too long to write inline.
14103 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl
14104 icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl -noflsh
14105 -ixoff -iutf8 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel -xcase -olcuc -ocrnl
14106 opost -ofill onlcr -onocr -onlret nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0 ff0
14107 isig -tostop -ofdel -echoprt echoctl echoke -extproc
14111 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
14115 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
14116 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
14117 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
14118 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
14125 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
14126 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -icanon -opost
14127 -isig -iuclc -ixany -imaxbel -xcase min 1 time 0
14131 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
14135 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
14140 @cindex eight-bit characters
14141 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
14142 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
14146 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
14147 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
14151 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14155 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated. If negated, same
14162 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
14163 (Used for terminals with uppercase characters only.)
14167 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
14171 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
14176 @subsection Special characters
14178 @cindex special characters
14179 @cindex characters, special
14181 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
14182 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
14183 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
14184 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
14185 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
14186 any other digit to indicate decimal.
14188 @cindex disabling special characters
14189 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
14190 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
14191 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
14192 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
14193 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
14194 special character to @key{U}.)
14200 Send an interrupt signal.
14204 Send a quit signal.
14208 Erase the last character typed.
14212 Erase the current line.
14216 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
14224 Alternate character to end the line. Non-POSIX.
14229 Alternate character to toggle discarding of output. Non-POSIX.
14233 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-POSIX.
14237 Send an info signal. Not currently supported on Linux. Non-POSIX.
14241 Restart the output after stopping it.
14249 Send a terminal stop signal.
14253 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-POSIX.
14257 Redraw the current line. Non-POSIX.
14261 Erase the last word typed. Non-POSIX.
14265 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
14266 character. Non-POSIX.
14271 @subsection Special settings
14273 @cindex special settings
14278 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
14279 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
14283 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
14284 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
14286 @item ispeed @var{n}
14288 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
14290 @item ospeed @var{n}
14292 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
14296 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows.
14300 @itemx columns @var{n}
14303 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-POSIX.
14309 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
14310 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
14311 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
14312 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
14317 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-POSIX.
14321 Print the terminal speed.
14324 @cindex baud rate, setting
14325 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
14326 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
14327 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
14328 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
14329 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
14346 4000000 where the system supports these.
14347 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
14351 @node printenv invocation
14352 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
14355 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
14356 @cindex environment variables, printing
14358 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
14361 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
14364 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
14365 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
14366 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
14368 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14376 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
14380 0 if all variables specified were found
14381 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
14382 2 if a write error occurred
14386 @node tty invocation
14387 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
14390 @cindex print terminal file name
14391 @cindex terminal file name, printing
14393 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
14394 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
14398 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
14401 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14411 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
14415 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
14419 0 if standard input is a terminal
14420 1 if standard input is not a terminal
14421 2 if given incorrect arguments
14422 3 if a write error occurs
14426 @node User information
14427 @chapter User information
14429 @cindex user information, commands for
14430 @cindex commands for printing user information
14432 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
14433 logins, groups, and so forth.
14436 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
14437 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
14438 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
14439 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
14440 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
14441 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
14445 @node id invocation
14446 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
14449 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
14450 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
14451 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
14453 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
14454 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
14457 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user}]
14460 @var{user} can be either a user ID or a name, with name look-up
14461 taking precedence unless the ID is specified with a leading @samp{+}.
14462 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
14464 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
14465 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
14466 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
14467 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
14468 In addition, if SELinux
14469 is enabled and the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is not set,
14470 then print @samp{context=@var{c}}, where @var{c} is the security context.
14472 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
14473 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
14475 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
14476 Also see @ref{Common options}.
14483 Print only the group ID.
14489 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
14495 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
14496 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
14502 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID@. Requires
14503 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
14509 Print only the user ID.
14516 @cindex security context
14517 Print only the security context of the process, which is generally
14518 the user's security context inherited from the parent process.
14519 If neither SELinux or SMACK is enabled then print a warning and
14520 set the exit status to 1.
14526 Delimit output items with NUL characters.
14527 This option is not permitted when using the default format.
14532 users <NUL> devs <NUL>
14537 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
14538 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
14539 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
14540 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
14541 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
14542 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
14543 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
14545 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
14549 @node logname invocation
14550 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
14553 @cindex printing user's login name
14554 @cindex login name, printing
14555 @cindex user name, printing
14558 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
14559 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14560 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
14561 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
14562 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
14564 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14570 @node whoami invocation
14571 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
14574 @cindex effective user ID, printing
14575 @cindex printing the effective user ID
14577 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
14578 effective user ID@. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
14580 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14586 @node groups invocation
14587 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
14590 @cindex printing groups a user is in
14591 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
14593 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
14594 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
14595 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
14597 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
14598 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
14601 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
14604 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
14606 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14609 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
14613 @node users invocation
14614 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
14617 @cindex printing current usernames
14618 @cindex usernames, printing current
14620 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
14621 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
14622 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
14623 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
14624 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
14633 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
14634 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14635 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
14636 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
14638 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14641 The @command{users} command is installed only on platforms with the
14642 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
14643 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
14648 @node who invocation
14649 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
14652 @cindex printing current user information
14653 @cindex information, about current users
14655 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
14659 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
14662 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
14664 @cindex remote hostname
14665 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
14666 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
14667 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
14671 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
14672 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
14673 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
14674 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
14675 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
14679 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
14680 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
14681 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
14682 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
14685 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
14686 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
14687 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
14688 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
14690 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14698 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
14704 Print the date and time of last system boot.
14710 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
14716 Print a line of column headings.
14722 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
14723 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
14727 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
14728 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
14729 automatic dial-up internet access.
14733 Same as @samp{who am i}.
14739 List active processes spawned by init.
14745 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
14746 Overrides all other options.
14751 @opindex --runlevel
14752 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
14756 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
14762 Print last system clock change.
14767 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
14768 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
14769 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
14780 @opindex --writable
14781 @cindex message status
14782 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
14783 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
14786 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
14787 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
14788 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
14793 The @command{who} command is installed only on platforms with the
14794 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
14795 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
14800 @node System context
14801 @chapter System context
14803 @cindex system context
14804 @cindex context, system
14805 @cindex commands for system context
14807 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
14811 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
14812 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
14813 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors.
14814 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
14815 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
14816 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
14817 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load.
14820 @node date invocation
14821 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
14824 @cindex time, printing or setting
14825 @cindex printing the current time
14830 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
14831 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
14832 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
14836 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
14837 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
14838 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
14839 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
14842 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
14843 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
14844 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
14845 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
14847 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
14848 @cindex time formats
14849 @cindex formatting times
14850 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
14851 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
14852 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
14853 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
14854 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
14855 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
14861 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
14862 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
14863 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
14864 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
14865 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
14866 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
14868 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
14870 * Examples of date:: Examples.
14873 @node Time conversion specifiers
14874 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
14876 @cindex time conversion specifiers
14877 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
14879 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
14883 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
14885 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
14887 hour, space padded (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}); equivalent to @samp{%_H}@.
14888 This is a GNU extension.
14890 hour, space padded (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}); equivalent to @samp{%_I}@.
14891 This is a GNU extension.
14893 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
14895 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
14896 This is a GNU extension.
14898 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
14899 blank in many locales.
14900 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
14902 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
14903 This is a GNU extension.
14905 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
14907 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
14909 @cindex epoch, seconds since
14910 @cindex seconds since the epoch
14911 @cindex beginning of time
14912 @cindex leap seconds
14913 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC@.
14914 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
14915 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
14916 This is a GNU extension.
14918 @cindex leap seconds
14919 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
14920 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
14922 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
14924 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
14926 @w{RFC 2822/ISO 8601} style numeric time zone
14927 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
14928 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
14929 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
14930 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
14931 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
14932 by the @option{--date} option.
14934 @w{RFC 3339/ISO 8601} style numeric time zone with
14935 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
14936 zone is determinable.
14937 This is a GNU extension.
14939 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
14940 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
14942 This is a GNU extension.
14944 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
14945 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
14946 no time zone is determinable.
14947 This is a GNU extension.
14949 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
14950 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
14954 @node Date conversion specifiers
14955 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
14957 @cindex date conversion specifiers
14958 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
14960 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
14964 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
14966 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
14968 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
14970 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
14972 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
14974 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
14975 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
14976 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
14977 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
14979 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
14981 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
14983 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
14985 full date in ISO 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
14986 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
14987 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
14990 year corresponding to the ISO week number, but without the century
14991 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
14992 as @samp{%y}, except that if the ISO week number (see
14994 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
14996 year corresponding to the ISO week number. This has the
14997 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the ISO
14999 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
15001 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
15002 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
15003 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
15007 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
15009 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
15011 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
15013 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
15014 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15015 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
15017 ISO week number, that is, the
15018 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
15019 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15020 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
15021 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
15022 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the ISO 8601
15025 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
15027 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
15028 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
15029 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
15031 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
15033 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
15035 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
15036 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
15037 precedes year @samp{0000}.
15041 @node Literal conversion specifiers
15042 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
15044 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
15045 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
15047 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
15059 @node Padding and other flags
15060 @subsection Padding and other flags
15062 @cindex numeric field padding
15063 @cindex padding of numeric fields
15064 @cindex fields, padding numeric
15066 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
15067 with zeros, so that, for
15068 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
15069 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
15070 since there is no natural width for them.
15072 As a GNU extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
15073 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
15077 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
15080 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
15081 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
15083 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
15084 would normally pad with spaces.
15086 Use upper case characters if possible.
15088 Use opposite case characters if possible.
15089 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
15093 Here are some examples of padding:
15096 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
15098 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
15100 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
15104 As a GNU extension, you can specify the field width
15105 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
15106 output of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
15107 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
15108 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
15109 a field of width 9.
15111 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
15112 specification. The modifiers are:
15116 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
15117 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
15118 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
15119 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
15123 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
15124 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
15127 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
15128 is available, it is ignored.
15131 @node Setting the time
15132 @subsection Setting the time
15134 @cindex setting the time
15135 @cindex time setting
15136 @cindex appropriate privileges
15138 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
15139 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
15140 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
15141 system clock. Note for changes to persist across a reboot, the
15142 hardware clock may need to be updated from the system clock, which
15143 might not happen automatically on your system.
15145 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
15158 first two digits of year (optional)
15160 last two digits of year (optional)
15165 Note, the @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be used with an
15166 argument in the above format. The @option{--universal} option may be used
15167 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
15168 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time zone.
15171 @node Options for date
15172 @subsection Options for @command{date}
15174 @cindex @command{date} options
15175 @cindex options for @command{date}
15177 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15181 @item -d @var{datestr}
15182 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
15185 @cindex parsing date strings
15186 @cindex date strings, parsing
15187 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
15190 @opindex next @var{day}
15191 @opindex last @var{day}
15192 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
15193 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
15194 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
15195 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
15196 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
15197 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
15198 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of UTC.@*
15199 Note: input currently must be in locale independent format. E.g., the
15200 LC_TIME=C below is needed to print back the correct date in many locales:
15202 date -d "$(LC_TIME=C date)"
15204 @xref{Date input formats}.
15206 @item -f @var{datefile}
15207 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
15210 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
15211 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
15212 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
15213 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
15216 @item -I[@var{timespec}]
15217 @itemx --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
15218 @opindex -I[@var{timespec}]
15219 @opindex --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
15220 Display the date using the ISO 8601 format, @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
15222 The argument @var{timespec} specifies the number of additional
15223 terms of the time to include. It can be one of the following:
15226 Print just the date. This is the default if @var{timespec} is omitted.
15229 Append the hour of the day to the date.
15232 Append the hours and minutes.
15235 Append the hours, minutes and seconds.
15238 Append the hours, minutes, seconds and nanoseconds.
15241 If showing any time terms, then include the time zone using the format
15244 @item -r @var{file}
15245 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
15247 @opindex --reference
15248 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
15249 instead of the current date and time.
15256 @opindex --rfc-2822
15257 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
15258 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
15262 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
15265 This format conforms to
15266 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
15268 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
15269 current and previous standards for Internet email.
15271 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
15272 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
15273 Display the date using a format specified by
15274 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
15275 RFC 3339}. This is a subset of the ISO 8601
15276 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
15277 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
15278 standard formats, RFC 3339 format is always suitable as
15279 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
15280 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
15282 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
15283 It can be one of the following:
15287 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
15288 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
15291 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
15292 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
15293 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
15294 hours and thirty minutes east of UTC@. This is equivalent to
15295 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
15298 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
15299 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
15300 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
15304 @item -s @var{datestr}
15305 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
15308 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
15309 See also @ref{Setting the time}.
15316 @opindex --universal
15317 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
15319 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
15321 @cindex leap seconds
15323 Use Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) by operating as if the
15324 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
15326 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (GMT) for
15327 historical reasons.
15328 Typically, systems ignore leap seconds and thus implement an
15329 approximation to UTC rather than true UTC.
15333 @node Examples of date
15334 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
15336 @cindex examples of @command{date}
15338 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
15339 option in the previous section.
15344 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
15347 date --date='2 days ago'
15351 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
15354 date --date='3 months 1 day'
15358 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
15361 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
15365 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
15371 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
15372 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
15373 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
15376 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
15377 of the month, you can use the (GNU extension)
15378 @samp{-} flag to suppress
15379 the padding altogether:
15382 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
15386 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
15387 non-GNU versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
15390 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
15394 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
15397 date --set='+2 minutes'
15401 To print the date in RFC 2822 format,
15402 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
15405 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
15408 @anchor{%s-examples}
15410 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
15411 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
15412 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
15413 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
15414 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
15418 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
15422 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
15423 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
15424 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
15425 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
15426 seconds) behind UTC:
15429 # local time zone used
15430 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
15435 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
15436 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
15437 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
15438 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
15441 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
15445 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
15446 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
15447 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
15448 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
15449 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
15452 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
15456 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
15457 a more readable form, use a command like this:
15460 # local time zone used
15461 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
15462 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
15465 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
15466 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
15469 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
15470 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
15473 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
15476 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
15477 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
15481 @cindex leap seconds
15482 Typically the seconds count omits leap seconds, but some systems are
15483 exceptions. Because leap seconds are not predictable, the mapping
15484 between the seconds count and a future timestamp is not reliable on
15485 the atypical systems that include leap seconds in their counts.
15487 Here is how the two kinds of systems handle the leap second at
15488 2012-06-30 23:59:60 UTC:
15491 # Typical systems ignore leap seconds:
15492 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
15494 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
15495 date: invalid date '2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000'
15496 date --date='2012-07-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
15501 # Atypical systems count leap seconds:
15502 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
15504 date --date='2012-06-30 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
15506 date --date='2012-07-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
15513 @node arch invocation
15514 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
15517 @cindex print machine hardware name
15518 @cindex system information, printing
15520 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
15521 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
15525 arch [@var{option}]
15528 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
15530 @command{arch} is not installed by default, so portable scripts should
15531 not rely on its existence.
15536 @node nproc invocation
15537 @section @command{nproc}: Print the number of available processors
15540 @cindex Print the number of processors
15541 @cindex system information, printing
15543 Print the number of processing units available to the current process,
15544 which may be less than the number of online processors.
15545 If this information is not accessible, then print the number of
15546 processors installed. If the @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is
15547 set, then it will determine the returned value. The result is guaranteed to be
15548 greater than zero. Synopsis:
15551 nproc [@var{option}]
15554 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15560 Print the number of installed processors on the system, which may
15561 be greater than the number online or available to the current process.
15562 The @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} environment variable is not honored in this case.
15564 @item --ignore=@var{number}
15566 If possible, exclude this @var{number} of processing units.
15573 @node uname invocation
15574 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
15577 @cindex print system information
15578 @cindex system information, printing
15580 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
15581 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
15582 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
15585 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
15588 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
15589 printed in this order:
15592 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
15593 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
15596 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
15597 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
15598 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
15602 @result{} Linux dumdum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686@c
15603 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
15607 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15615 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
15616 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
15619 @itemx --hardware-platform
15621 @opindex --hardware-platform
15622 @cindex implementation, hardware
15623 @cindex hardware platform
15624 @cindex platform, hardware
15625 Print the hardware platform name
15626 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
15627 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
15628 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
15634 @cindex machine type
15635 @cindex hardware class
15636 @cindex hardware type
15637 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
15643 @opindex --nodename
15646 @cindex network node name
15647 Print the network node hostname.
15652 @opindex --processor
15653 @cindex host processor type
15654 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
15655 architecture or ISA).
15656 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
15657 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
15660 @itemx --operating-system
15662 @opindex --operating-system
15663 @cindex operating system name
15664 Print the name of the operating system.
15667 @itemx --kernel-release
15669 @opindex --kernel-release
15670 @cindex kernel release
15671 @cindex release of kernel
15672 Print the kernel release.
15675 @itemx --kernel-name
15677 @opindex --kernel-name
15678 @cindex kernel name
15679 @cindex name of kernel
15680 Print the kernel name.
15681 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
15682 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
15683 POSIX specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
15684 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
15685 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
15686 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
15687 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
15691 @itemx --kernel-version
15693 @opindex --kernel-version
15694 @cindex kernel version
15695 @cindex version of kernel
15696 Print the kernel version.
15703 @node hostname invocation
15704 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
15707 @cindex setting the hostname
15708 @cindex printing the hostname
15709 @cindex system name, printing
15710 @cindex appropriate privileges
15712 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
15713 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
15714 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
15718 hostname [@var{name}]
15721 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
15724 @command{hostname} is not installed by default, and other packages
15725 also supply a @command{hostname} command, so portable scripts should
15726 not rely on its existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
15731 @node hostid invocation
15732 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier
15735 @cindex printing the host identifier
15737 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
15738 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
15739 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
15740 @xref{Common options}.
15742 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
15749 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
15750 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
15753 @command{hostid} is installed only on systems that have the
15754 @code{gethostid} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
15759 @node uptime invocation
15760 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
15763 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
15765 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
15766 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
15768 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
15769 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
15770 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
15771 the default setting).
15773 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
15774 @xref{Common options}.
15776 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
15780 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
15783 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
15784 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
15785 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
15786 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
15787 those processes which are waiting for disk I/O). The Linux kernel
15788 includes uninterruptible processes.
15790 @command{uptime} is installed only on platforms with infrastructure
15791 for obtaining the boot time, and other packages also supply an
15792 @command{uptime} command, so portable scripts should not rely on its
15793 existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
15797 @node SELinux context
15798 @chapter SELinux context
15800 @cindex SELinux context
15801 @cindex SELinux, context
15802 @cindex commands for SELinux context
15804 This section describes commands for operations with SELinux
15808 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
15809 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
15812 @node chcon invocation
15813 @section @command{chcon}: Change SELinux context of file
15816 @cindex changing security context
15817 @cindex change SELinux context
15819 @command{chcon} changes the SELinux security context of the selected files.
15823 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{context} @var{file}@dots{}
15824 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-l @var{range}]@c
15825 [-t @var{type}] @var{file}@dots{}
15826 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} --reference=@var{rfile} @var{file}@dots{}
15829 Change the SELinux security context of each @var{file} to @var{context}.
15830 With @option{--reference}, change the security context of each @var{file}
15831 to that of @var{rfile}.
15833 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15837 @item --dereference
15838 @opindex --dereference
15839 Do not affect symbolic links but what they refer to; this is the default.
15842 @itemx --no-dereference
15844 @opindex --no-dereference
15845 @cindex no dereference
15846 Affect the symbolic links themselves instead of any referenced file.
15848 @item --reference=@var{rfile}
15849 @opindex --reference
15850 @cindex reference file
15851 Use @var{rfile}'s security context rather than specifying a @var{context} value.
15856 @opindex --recursive
15857 Operate on files and directories recursively.
15859 @item --preserve-root
15860 @opindex --preserve-root
15861 Refuse to operate recursively on the root directory, @file{/},
15862 when used together with the @option{--recursive} option.
15863 @xref{Treating / specially}.
15865 @item --no-preserve-root
15866 @opindex --no-preserve-root
15867 Do not treat the root directory, @file{/}, specially when operating
15868 recursively; this is the default.
15869 @xref{Treating / specially}.
15872 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15875 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15878 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
15885 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
15887 @item -u @var{user}
15888 @itemx --user=@var{user}
15891 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
15893 @item -r @var{role}
15894 @itemx --role=@var{role}
15897 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
15899 @item -t @var{type}
15900 @itemx --type=@var{type}
15903 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
15905 @item -l @var{range}
15906 @itemx --range=@var{range}
15909 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
15915 @node runcon invocation
15916 @section @command{runcon}: Run a command in specified SELinux context
15919 @cindex run with security context
15922 @command{runcon} runs file in specified SELinux security context.
15926 runcon @var{context} @var{command} [@var{args}]
15927 runcon [ -c ] [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-t @var{type}]@c
15928 [-l @var{range}] @var{command} [@var{args}]
15931 Run @var{command} with completely-specified @var{context}, or with
15932 current or transitioned security context modified by one or more of @var{level},
15933 @var{role}, @var{type} and @var{user}.
15935 If none of @option{-c}, @option{-t}, @option{-u}, @option{-r}, or @option{-l}
15936 is specified, the first argument is used as the complete context.
15937 Any additional arguments after @var{command}
15938 are interpreted as arguments to the command.
15940 With neither @var{context} nor @var{command}, print the current
15943 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15951 Compute process transition context before modifying.
15953 @item -u @var{user}
15954 @itemx --user=@var{user}
15957 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
15959 @item -r @var{role}
15960 @itemx --role=@var{role}
15963 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
15965 @item -t @var{type}
15966 @itemx --type=@var{type}
15969 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
15971 @item -l @var{range}
15972 @itemx --range=@var{range}
15975 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
15979 @cindex exit status of @command{runcon}
15983 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
15984 127 if @command{runcon} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
15985 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
15988 @node Modified command invocation
15989 @chapter Modified command invocation
15991 @cindex modified command invocation
15992 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
15993 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
15995 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
15996 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
16000 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
16001 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
16002 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
16003 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
16004 * stdbuf invocation:: Modify buffering of standard streams.
16005 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
16009 @node chroot invocation
16010 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
16013 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
16014 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
16016 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
16017 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
16018 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
16019 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
16020 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
16021 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.
16022 Furthermore, the @command{chroot} command avoids the @code{chroot} system call
16023 when @var{newroot} is identical to the old @file{/} directory for consistency
16024 with systems where this is allowed for non-privileged users.}.
16028 chroot @var{option} @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
16029 chroot @var{option}
16032 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
16033 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
16034 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist), then changes the working
16035 directory to @file{/}, and finally runs @var{command} with optional @var{args}.
16036 If @var{command} is not specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL}
16037 environment variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the
16038 @option{-i} option.
16039 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
16040 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
16042 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16043 Options must precede operands.
16047 @item --groups=@var{groups}
16049 Use this option to override the supplementary @var{groups} to be
16050 used by the new process.
16051 The items in the list (names or numeric IDs) must be separated by commas.
16052 Use @samp{--groups=''} to disable the supplementary group look-up
16053 implicit in the @option{--userspec} option.
16055 @item --userspec=@var{user}[:@var{group}]
16056 @opindex --userspec
16057 By default, @var{command} is run with the same credentials
16058 as the invoking process.
16059 Use this option to run it as a different @var{user} and/or with a
16060 different primary @var{group}.
16061 If a @var{user} is specified then the supplementary groups
16062 are set according to the system defined list for that user,
16063 unless overridden with the @option{--groups} option.
16066 @opindex --skip-chdir
16067 Use this option to not change the working directory to @file{/} after changing
16068 the root directory to @var{newroot}, i.e., inside the chroot.
16069 This option is only permitted when @var{newroot} is the old @file{/} directory,
16070 and therefore is mostly useful together with the @option{--groups} and
16071 @option{--userspec} options to retain the previous working directory.
16075 The user and group name look-up performed by the @option{--userspec}
16076 and @option{--groups} options, is done both outside and inside
16077 the chroot, with successful look-ups inside the chroot taking precedence.
16078 If the specified user or group items are intended to represent a numeric ID,
16079 then a name to ID resolving step is avoided by specifying a leading @samp{+}.
16080 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
16082 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
16083 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
16084 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
16085 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
16086 your new root directory.
16088 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
16089 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
16092 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
16095 Then you'll see output like this:
16100 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
16103 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
16104 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
16105 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
16106 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
16107 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
16108 device files), copy them into place, too.
16110 @command{chroot} is installed only on systems that have the
16111 @code{chroot} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
16114 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
16118 125 if @command{chroot} itself fails
16119 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16120 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16121 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16125 @node env invocation
16126 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
16129 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
16130 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
16131 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
16133 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
16136 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
16137 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
16141 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
16142 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
16143 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
16144 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
16145 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
16146 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
16148 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
16149 characters other than @samp{=} and ASCII NUL.
16150 However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
16151 consist solely of underscores, digits, and ASCII letters,
16152 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
16153 work well with other names.
16156 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
16157 specifies the program to invoke; it is
16158 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
16159 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
16160 The program should not be a special built-in utility
16161 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
16163 Modifications to @env{PATH} take effect prior to searching for
16164 @var{command}. Use caution when reducing @env{PATH}; behavior is
16165 not portable when @env{PATH} is undefined or omits key directories
16166 such as @file{/bin}.
16168 In the rare case that a utility contains a @samp{=} in the name, the
16169 only way to disambiguate it from a variable assignment is to use an
16170 intermediate command for @var{command}, and pass the problematic
16171 program name via @var{args}. For example, if @file{./prog=} is an
16172 executable in the current @env{PATH}:
16175 env prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
16176 env ./prog= true # runs 'true', with ./prog= in environment
16177 env -- prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
16178 env sh -c '\prog= true' # runs 'prog=' with argument 'true'
16179 env sh -c 'exec "$@@"' sh prog= true # also runs 'prog='
16182 @cindex environment, printing
16184 If no command name is specified following the environment
16185 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
16186 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
16188 For some examples, suppose the environment passed to @command{env}
16189 contains @samp{LOGNAME=rms}, @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and
16190 @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}:
16195 Output the current environment.
16197 $ env | LC_ALL=C sort
16200 PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks
16204 Run @command{foo} with a reduced environment, preserving only the
16205 original @env{PATH} to avoid problems in locating @command{foo}.
16207 env - PATH="$PATH" foo
16211 Run @command{foo} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=rms},
16212 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and guarantees
16213 that @command{foo} was found in the file system rather than as a shell
16220 Run @command{nemacs} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=foo},
16221 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and
16222 @samp{DISPLAY=gnu:0}.
16224 env DISPLAY=gnu:0 LOGNAME=foo nemacs
16228 Attempt to run the program @command{/energy/--} (as that is the only
16229 possible path search result); if the command exists, the environment
16230 will contain @samp{LOGNAME=rms} and @samp{PATH=/energy}, and the
16231 arguments will be @samp{e=mc2}, @samp{bar}, and @samp{baz}.
16233 env -u EDITOR PATH=/energy -- e=mc2 bar baz
16239 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16240 Options must precede operands.
16246 @item -u @var{name}
16247 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
16250 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
16255 @itemx --ignore-environment
16258 @opindex --ignore-environment
16259 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
16263 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
16267 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
16268 125 if @command{env} itself fails
16269 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16270 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16271 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16275 @node nice invocation
16276 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
16280 @cindex scheduling, affecting
16281 @cindex appropriate privileges
16283 @command{nice} prints a process's @dfn{niceness}, or runs
16284 a command with modified niceness. @dfn{niceness} affects how
16285 favorably the process is scheduled in the system.
16289 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
16292 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
16293 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
16294 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
16296 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
16297 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
16298 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
16299 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
16300 may have a wider range of niceness values; conversely, other systems may
16301 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
16302 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
16303 minimum or maximum supported value.
16305 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
16306 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
16307 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
16308 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
16309 terminology, POSIX defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
16310 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the non-negative difference
16311 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
16312 conforms to POSIX, its documentation and diagnostics use the
16313 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
16315 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16316 built-in utilities}).
16318 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{nice}
16320 Note to change the @dfn{niceness} of an existing process,
16321 one needs to use the @command{renice} command.
16323 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16324 Options must precede operands.
16327 @item -n @var{adjustment}
16328 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
16330 @opindex --adjustment
16331 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
16332 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
16333 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
16336 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
16337 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
16338 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
16342 @command{nice} is installed only on systems that have the POSIX
16343 @code{setpriority} function, so portable scripts should not rely on
16344 its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16346 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
16350 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
16351 125 if @command{nice} itself fails
16352 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16353 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16354 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16357 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
16360 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
16363 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
16364 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
16366 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
16377 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
16378 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
16379 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
16383 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
16387 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
16388 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
16391 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
16395 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
16399 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
16401 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
16406 @node nohup invocation
16407 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
16410 @cindex hangups, immunity to
16411 @cindex immunity to hangups
16412 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
16415 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
16416 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
16420 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16423 If standard input is a terminal, redirect it so that terminal sessions
16424 do not mistakenly consider the terminal to be used by the command.
16425 Make the substitute file descriptor unreadable, so that commands that
16426 mistakenly attempt to read from standard input can report an error.
16427 This redirection is a GNU extension; programs intended to be portable
16428 to non-GNU hosts can use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16429 0>/dev/null} instead.
16432 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
16433 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
16434 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
16435 command is not run.
16436 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
16437 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
16438 regardless of the current umask settings.
16440 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
16441 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
16442 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
16443 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
16444 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
16446 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
16447 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
16451 nohup make > make.log
16454 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
16455 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
16456 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
16457 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
16458 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
16460 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16461 built-in utilities}).
16463 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16464 options}. Options must precede operands.
16466 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
16470 125 if @command{nohup} itself fails, and @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set
16471 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16472 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16473 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16476 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, internal failures give status 127
16480 @node stdbuf invocation
16481 @section @command{stdbuf}: Run a command with modified I/O stream buffering
16484 @cindex standard streams, buffering
16485 @cindex line buffered
16487 @command{stdbuf} allows one to modify the buffering operations of the
16488 three standard I/O streams associated with a program. Synopsis:
16491 stdbuf @var{option}@dots{} @var{command}
16494 @var{command} must start with the name of a program that
16497 uses the ISO C @code{FILE} streams for input/output (note the
16498 programs @command{dd} and @command{cat} don't do that),
16501 does not adjust the buffering of its standard streams (note the
16502 program @command{tee} is not in this category).
16505 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
16508 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16512 @item -i @var{mode}
16513 @itemx --input=@var{mode}
16516 Adjust the standard input stream buffering.
16518 @item -o @var{mode}
16519 @itemx --output=@var{mode}
16522 Adjust the standard output stream buffering.
16524 @item -e @var{mode}
16525 @itemx --error=@var{mode}
16528 Adjust the standard error stream buffering.
16532 The @var{mode} can be specified as follows:
16537 Set the stream to line buffered mode.
16538 In this mode data is coalesced until a newline is output or
16539 input is read from any stream attached to a terminal device.
16540 This option is invalid with standard input.
16543 Disable buffering of the selected stream.
16544 In this mode, data is output immediately and only the
16545 amount of data requested is read from input.
16546 Note the difference in function for input and output.
16547 Disabling buffering for input will not influence the responsiveness
16548 or blocking behavior of the stream input functions.
16549 For example @code{fread} will still block until @code{EOF} or error,
16550 even if the underlying @code{read} returns less data than requested.
16553 Specify the size of the buffer to use in fully buffered mode.
16554 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
16558 @command{stdbuf} is installed only on platforms that use the
16559 Executable and Linkable Format (ELF) and support the
16560 @code{constructor} attribute, so portable scripts should not rely on
16563 @cindex exit status of @command{stdbuf}
16567 125 if @command{stdbuf} itself fails
16568 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16569 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16570 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16574 @node timeout invocation
16575 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
16579 @cindex run commands with bounded time
16581 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
16582 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
16585 timeout [@var{option}] @var{duration} @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
16588 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
16589 built-in utilities}).
16591 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16592 Options must precede operands.
16595 @item --preserve-status
16596 @opindex --preserve-status
16597 Return the exit status of the managed @var{command} on timeout, rather than
16598 a specific exit status indicating a timeout. This is useful if the
16599 managed @var{command} supports running for an indeterminate amount of time.
16602 @opindex --foreground
16603 Don't create a separate background program group, so that
16604 the managed @var{command} can use the foreground TTY normally.
16605 This is needed to support timing out commands not started
16606 directly from an interactive shell, in two situations.
16609 @var{command} is interactive and needs to read from the terminal for example
16611 the user wants to support sending signals directly to @var{command}
16612 from the terminal (like Ctrl-C for example)
16615 Note in this mode of operation, any children of @var{command}
16616 will not be timed out. Also SIGCONT will not be sent to @var{command},
16617 as it's generally not needed with foreground processes, and can
16618 cause intermittent signal delivery issues with programs that are monitors
16619 themselves (like GDB for example).
16621 @item -k @var{duration}
16622 @itemx --kill-after=@var{duration}
16624 @opindex --kill-after
16625 Ensure the monitored @var{command} is killed by also sending a @samp{KILL}
16626 signal, after the specified @var{duration}. Without this option, if the
16627 selected signal proves not to be fatal, @command{timeout} does not kill
16630 @item -s @var{signal}
16631 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
16634 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
16635 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
16636 or a number. @xref{Signal specifications}.
16640 @var{duration} is a floating point number followed by an optional unit:
16642 @samp{s} for seconds (the default)
16643 @samp{m} for minutes
16647 A duration of 0 disables the associated timeout.
16648 Note that the actual timeout duration is dependent on system conditions,
16649 which should be especially considered when specifying sub-second timeouts.
16651 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
16655 124 if @var{command} times out
16656 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
16657 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
16658 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
16659 137 if @var{command} is sent the KILL(9) signal (128+9)
16660 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
16664 @node Process control
16665 @chapter Process control
16667 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
16668 @cindex commands for controlling processes
16671 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
16675 @node kill invocation
16676 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
16679 @cindex send a signal to processes
16681 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
16682 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
16683 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
16686 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
16687 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
16690 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{kill}
16692 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
16693 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
16694 is @samp{TERM}@. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
16695 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
16696 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
16698 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
16699 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
16700 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
16701 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
16702 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
16703 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
16704 value of @var{pid}.
16706 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
16707 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
16710 If a negative @var{pid} argument is desired as the first one, it
16711 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
16712 POSIX, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
16713 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
16722 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
16723 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
16725 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
16726 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
16727 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
16728 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
16729 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
16730 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
16731 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
16732 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
16733 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
16734 and if there is no output error.
16736 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
16737 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
16739 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
16740 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
16741 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
16742 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
16743 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
16744 ambiguity with lower case option letters.
16745 @xref{Signal specifications}, for a list of supported
16746 signal names and numbers.
16751 @cindex delaying commands
16752 @cindex commands for delaying
16754 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
16757 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
16761 @node sleep invocation
16762 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
16765 @cindex delay for a specified time
16767 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
16768 the values of the command line arguments.
16772 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
16776 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
16777 is seconds. The units are:
16790 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
16791 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
16792 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
16793 arbitrary floating point numbers. @xref{Floating point}.
16795 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16798 @c sleep is a shell built-in at least with Solaris 11's /bin/sh
16799 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{sleep}
16804 @node Numeric operations
16805 @chapter Numeric operations
16807 @cindex numeric operations
16808 These programs do numerically-related operations.
16811 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
16812 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers.
16813 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
16817 @node factor invocation
16818 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
16821 @cindex prime factors
16823 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
16826 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
16827 factor @var{option}
16830 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
16831 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
16833 The @command{factor} command supports only a small number of options:
16837 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
16841 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
16845 Factoring the product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes
16846 takes about 30 milliseconds of CPU time on a 2.2 GHz Athlon.
16849 M8=$(echo 2^31-1|bc)
16850 M9=$(echo 2^61-1|bc)
16851 n=$(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
16852 /usr/bin/time -f %U factor $n
16853 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
16857 Similarly, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256}+1} takes
16858 about 20 seconds on the same machine.
16860 Factoring large numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard-Brent rho
16861 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
16862 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
16863 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
16864 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
16866 If @command{factor} is built without using GNU MP, only
16867 single-precision arithmetic is available, and so large numbers
16868 (typically @math{2^{128}} and above) will not be supported.
16869 The single-precision code uses an algorithm which is designed
16870 for factoring smaller numbers.
16875 @node numfmt invocation
16876 @section @command{numfmt}: Reformat numbers
16880 @command{numfmt} reads numbers in various representations and reformats them
16881 as requested. The most common usage is converting numbers to/from @emph{human}
16882 representation (e.g. @samp{4G} @expansion{} @samp{4,000,000,000}).
16885 numfmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]
16888 @command{numfmt} converts each @var{number} on the command-line according to the
16889 specified options (see below). If no @var{number}s are given, it reads numbers
16890 from standard input. @command{numfmt} can optionally extract numbers from
16891 specific columns, maintaining proper line padding and alignment.
16895 See @option{--invalid} for additional information regarding exit status.
16897 @subsection General options
16899 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16905 Print (to standard error) warning messages about possible erroneous usage.
16908 @itemx --delimiter=@var{d}
16910 @opindex --delimiter
16911 Use the character @var{d} as input field separator (default: whitespace).
16912 @emph{Note}: Using non-default delimiter turns off automatic padding.
16914 @item --field=@var{fields}
16916 Convert the number in input field @var{fields} (default: 1).
16917 @var{fields} supports @command{cut} style field ranges:
16920 N N'th field, counted from 1
16921 N- from N'th field, to end of line
16922 N-M from N'th to M'th field (inclusive)
16923 -M from first to M'th field (inclusive)
16928 @item --format=@var{format}
16930 Use printf-style floating FORMAT string. The @var{format} string must contain
16931 one @samp{%f} directive, optionally with @samp{'}, @samp{-}, @samp{0}, width
16932 or precision modifiers. The @samp{'} modifier will enable @option{--grouping},
16933 the @samp{-} modifier will enable left-aligned @option{--padding} and the width
16934 modifier will enable right-aligned @option{--padding}. The @samp{0} width
16935 modifier (without the @samp{-} modifier) will generate leading zeros on the
16936 number, up to the specified width. A precision specification like @samp{%.1f}
16937 will override the precision determined from the input data or set due to
16938 @option{--to} option auto scaling.
16940 @item --from=@var{unit}
16942 Auto-scales input numbers according to @var{unit}. See UNITS below.
16943 The default is no scaling, meaning suffixes (e.g. @samp{M}, @samp{G}) will
16946 @item --from-unit=@var{n}
16947 @opindex --from-unit
16948 Specify the input unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
16949 the input numbers represent other units (e.g. if the input number @samp{10}
16950 represents 10 units of 512 bytes, use @samp{--from-unit=512}).
16951 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
16954 @opindex --grouping
16955 Group digits in output numbers according to the current locale's grouping rules
16956 (e.g @emph{Thousands Separator} character, commonly @samp{.} (dot) or @samp{,}
16957 comma). This option has no effect in @samp{POSIX/C} locale.
16959 @item --header[=@var{n}]
16961 @opindex --header=N
16962 Print the first @var{n} (default: 1) lines without any conversion.
16964 @item --invalid=@var{mode}
16966 The default action on input errors is to exit immediately with status code 2.
16967 @option{--invalid=@samp{abort}} explicitly specifies this default mode.
16968 With a @var{mode} of @samp{fail}, print a warning for @emph{each} conversion
16969 error, and exit with status 2. With a @var{mode} of @samp{warn}, exit with
16970 status 0, even in the presence of conversion errors, and with a @var{mode} of
16971 @samp{ignore} do not even print diagnostics.
16973 @item --padding=@var{n}
16975 Pad the output numbers to @var{n} characters, by adding spaces. If @var{n} is
16976 a positive number, numbers will be right-aligned. If @var{n} is a negative
16977 number, numbers will be left-aligned. By default, numbers are automatically
16978 aligned based on the input line's width (only with the default delimiter).
16980 @item --round=@var{method}
16982 @opindex --round=up
16983 @opindex --round=down
16984 @opindex --round=from-zero
16985 @opindex --round=towards-zero
16986 @opindex --round=nearest
16987 When converting number representations, round the number according to
16988 @var{method}, which can be @samp{up}, @samp{down},
16989 @samp{from-zero} (the default), @samp{towards-zero}, @samp{nearest}.
16991 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
16993 Add @samp{SUFFIX} to the output numbers, and accept optional @samp{SUFFIX} in
16996 @item --to=@var{unit}
16998 Auto-scales output numbers according to @var{unit}. See @emph{Units} below.
16999 The default is no scaling, meaning all the digits of the number are printed.
17001 @item --to-unit=@var{n}
17003 Specify the output unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
17004 the output numbers represent other units (e.g. to represent @samp{4,000,000}
17005 bytes in blocks of 1KB, use @samp{--to=si --to-unit=1000}).
17006 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
17010 @subsection Possible @var{unit}s:
17012 The following are the possible @var{unit} options with @option{--from=UNITS} and
17013 @option{--to=UNITS}:
17018 No scaling is performed. For input numbers, no suffixes are accepted, and any
17019 trailing characters following the number will trigger an error. For output
17020 numbers, all digits of the numbers will be printed.
17023 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International System of Units (SI)}
17025 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17026 For output numbers, values larger than 1000 will be rounded, and printed with
17027 one of the following suffixes:
17030 @samp{K} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo)
17031 @samp{M} => @math{1000^2 = 10^6} (Mega)
17032 @samp{G} => @math{1000^3 = 10^9} (Giga)
17033 @samp{T} => @math{1000^4 = 10^{12}} (Tera)
17034 @samp{P} => @math{1000^5 = 10^{15}} (Peta)
17035 @samp{E} => @math{1000^6 = 10^{18}} (Exa)
17036 @samp{Z} => @math{1000^7 = 10^{21}} (Zetta)
17037 @samp{Y} => @math{1000^8 = 10^{24}} (Yotta)
17041 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
17042 Commission (IEC)} standard.
17043 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17044 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
17045 one of the following suffixes:
17048 @samp{K} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
17049 @samp{M} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
17050 @samp{G} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
17051 @samp{T} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
17052 @samp{P} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
17053 @samp{E} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
17054 @samp{Z} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
17055 @samp{Y} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
17058 The @option{iec} option uses a single letter suffix (e.g. @samp{G}), which is
17059 not fully standard, as the @emph{iec} standard recommends a two-letter symbol
17060 (e.g @samp{Gi}) - but in practice, this method common. Compare with
17061 the @option{iec-i} option.
17064 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
17065 Commission (IEC)} standard.
17066 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
17067 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
17068 one of the following suffixes:
17071 @samp{Ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
17072 @samp{Mi} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
17073 @samp{Gi} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
17074 @samp{Ti} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
17075 @samp{Pi} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
17076 @samp{Ei} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
17077 @samp{Zi} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
17078 @samp{Yi} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
17081 The @option{iec-i} option uses a two-letter suffix symbol (e.g. @samp{Gi}),
17082 as the @emph{iec} standard recommends, but this is not always common in
17083 practice. Compare with the @option{iec} option.
17086 @samp{auto} can only be used with @option{--from}. With this method, numbers
17087 with @samp{K},@samp{M},@samp{G},@samp{T},@samp{P},@samp{E},@samp{Z},@samp{Y}
17088 suffixes are interpreted as @emph{SI} values, and numbers with @samp{Ki},
17089 @samp{Mi},@samp{Gi},@samp{Ti},@samp{Pi},@samp{Ei},@samp{Zi},@samp{Yi} suffixes
17090 are interpreted as @emph{IEC} values.
17094 @subsection Examples of using @command{numfmt}
17096 Converting a single number from/to @emph{human} representation:
17098 $ numfmt --to=si 500000
17101 $ numfmt --to=iec 500000
17104 $ numfmt --to=iec-i 500000
17107 $ numfmt --from=si 1M
17110 $ numfmt --from=iec 1M
17113 # with '--from=auto', M=Mega, Mi=Mebi
17114 $ numfmt --from=auto 1M
17116 $ numfmt --from=auto 1Mi
17120 Converting from @samp{SI} to @samp{IEC} scales (e.g. when a harddisk capacity is
17121 advertised as @samp{1TB}, while checking the drive's capacity gives lower
17125 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec 1T
17130 Converting a single field from an input file / piped input (these contrived
17131 examples are for demonstration purposes only, as both @command{ls} and
17132 @command{df} support the @option{--human-readable} option to
17133 output sizes in human-readable format):
17136 # Third field (file size) will be shown in SI representation
17137 $ ls -log | numfmt --field 3 --header --to=si | head -n4
17138 -rw-r--r-- 1 94K Aug 23 2011 ABOUT-NLS
17139 -rw-r--r-- 1 3.7K Jan 7 16:15 AUTHORS
17140 -rw-r--r-- 1 36K Jun 1 2011 COPYING
17141 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jan 7 15:15 ChangeLog
17143 # Second field (size) will be shown in IEC representation
17144 $ df --block-size=1 | numfmt --field 2 --header --to=iec | head -n4
17145 File system 1B-blocks Used Available Use% Mounted on
17146 rootfs 132G 104741408 26554036 80% /
17147 tmpfs 794M 7580 804960 1% /run/shm
17148 /dev/sdb1 694G 651424756 46074696 94% /home
17152 Output can be tweaked using @option{--padding} or @option{--format}:
17155 # Pad to 10 characters, right-aligned
17156 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=10
17162 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned
17163 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=-10
17169 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
17170 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --format="%10f"
17176 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
17177 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding="%-10f"
17184 With locales that support grouping digits, using @option{--grouping} or
17185 @option{--format} enables grouping. In @samp{POSIX} locale, grouping is
17189 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17192 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17195 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
17198 $ LC_ALL=C ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17201 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17204 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'-15f==" 2G
17207 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN ./src/numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
17208 == 2,14,74,83,648==
17212 @node seq invocation
17213 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
17216 @cindex numeric sequences
17217 @cindex sequence of numbers
17219 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
17222 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
17223 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
17224 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
17227 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
17228 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
17229 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
17230 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
17231 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
17232 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
17233 The sequence of numbers ends when the sum of the current number and
17234 @var{increment} would become greater than @var{last},
17235 so @code{seq 1 10 10} only produces @samp{1}.
17236 Floating-point numbers may be specified. @xref{Floating point}.
17238 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17239 Options must precede operands.
17242 @item -f @var{format}
17243 @itemx --format=@var{format}
17244 @opindex -f @var{format}
17245 @opindex --format=@var{format}
17246 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
17247 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
17248 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
17249 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
17250 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}@.
17251 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
17252 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
17253 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
17254 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
17255 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
17256 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
17258 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
17259 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
17260 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
17261 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
17262 the default format is @samp{%g}.
17264 @item -s @var{string}
17265 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
17266 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
17267 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
17268 The output always terminates with a newline.
17271 @itemx --equal-width
17272 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
17273 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
17274 decimal representation.
17275 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
17279 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
17282 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
17288 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
17289 to perform the conversion:
17292 $ printf '%x\n' $(seq 1048575 1024 1050623)
17298 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
17299 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
17302 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
17308 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
17311 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
17312 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
17313 differ depending on your floating-point implementation.
17314 @xref{Floating point}. A common
17315 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
17316 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
17319 $ seq 50000000000000000000 2 50000000000000000004
17320 50000000000000000000
17321 50000000000000000000
17322 50000000000000000004
17325 However, note that when limited to non-negative whole numbers,
17326 an increment of 1 and no format-specifying option, seq can print
17327 arbitrarily large numbers.
17329 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
17330 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
17331 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
17332 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
17335 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
17338 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
17343 @node File permissions
17344 @chapter File permissions
17347 @include parse-datetime.texi
17351 @node Opening the software toolbox
17352 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
17354 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
17355 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
17356 @cite{What's GNU@?} column of the June 1994 @cite{Linux Journal}}.
17357 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
17360 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
17361 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
17362 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
17363 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
17364 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
17365 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
17366 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
17370 @node Toolbox introduction
17371 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
17373 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
17374 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system
17376 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
17377 of program development and usage.
17379 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
17380 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
17381 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
17382 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
17383 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
17384 for solving many kinds of problems.
17386 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
17387 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
17388 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
17389 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
17390 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
17392 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
17393 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
17394 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
17395 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
17396 with the handle of his screwdriver.
17398 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
17399 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
17400 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
17405 difficult to write,
17408 difficult to maintain and
17412 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
17415 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
17416 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
17417 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
17419 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
17420 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
17421 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
17422 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
17423 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
17424 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
17425 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
17426 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
17427 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
17429 @node I/O redirection
17430 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
17432 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
17433 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
17434 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
17435 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
17436 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
17437 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
17438 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
17439 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
17440 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
17443 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
17446 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
17449 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
17450 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
17451 it is in the desired form.
17453 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
17454 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
17455 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
17456 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
17457 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
17458 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
17459 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
17460 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
17461 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
17463 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
17464 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
17465 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
17466 lines delimited by the ASCII LF (Line Feed) character,
17467 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
17468 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
17469 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
17470 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
17471 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
17472 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
17473 data with a text editor.)
17475 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
17476 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
17477 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
17478 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
17479 for the full story.
17481 @node The who command
17482 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
17484 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
17485 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
17486 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
17491 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
17492 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
17493 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
17494 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
17497 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
17498 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
17499 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
17500 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
17501 but the data is not all that exciting.
17503 @node The cut command
17504 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
17506 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
17507 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
17508 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
17509 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
17513 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
17516 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
17519 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
17520 @print{} root:Operator
17522 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
17523 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
17527 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
17528 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
17529 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
17530 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
17532 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
17543 @node The sort command
17544 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
17546 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
17547 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
17548 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
17551 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
17552 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
17553 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
17554 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
17555 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
17558 @node The uniq command
17559 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
17561 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
17562 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
17563 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
17564 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
17565 standard input. It prints only one
17566 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
17567 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
17568 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
17571 @node Putting the tools together
17572 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
17574 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
17575 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a
17577 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
17578 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
17581 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
17582 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
17583 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
17584 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
17585 by generating just a list of logged on users:
17595 Next, sort the list:
17598 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
17605 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
17608 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
17614 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
17615 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
17616 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
17618 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it
17620 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
17621 or @code{root}, prompt):
17624 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
17625 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
17627 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
17630 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
17631 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
17632 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
17633 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
17634 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
17635 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
17636 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
17639 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
17640 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
17641 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
17643 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
17644 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
17645 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
17647 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
17648 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
17649 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
17652 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
17653 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
17655 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
17656 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
17657 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
17661 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
17662 @print{} this example has mixed case!
17665 There are several options of interest:
17669 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
17670 operations apply to characters not in the given set
17673 delete characters in the first set from the output
17676 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
17679 We will be using all three options in a moment.
17681 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
17682 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
17683 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
17684 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
17685 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
17686 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
17687 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
17709 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
17710 instead of a regular file.
17712 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
17713 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
17716 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
17717 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
17720 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
17723 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
17724 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
17728 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
17731 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
17732 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
17733 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
17734 be left alone. (The ASCII tab character should also be included for
17735 good measure in a production script.)
17737 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
17738 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
17739 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
17740 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
17743 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17744 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
17747 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
17748 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
17749 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
17750 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
17751 typing in all of a command.)
17753 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
17754 case. We're ready to count each word:
17757 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17758 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
17761 At this point, the data might look something like this:
17774 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
17775 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
17776 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
17780 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
17783 reverse the order of the sort
17786 The final pipeline looks like this:
17789 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17790 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
17799 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
17800 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
17801 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
17802 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
17804 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
17805 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
17806 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
17807 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
17808 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
17809 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
17810 revision of this article.}
17811 this is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
17813 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
17814 a sorted list of words, one per line:
17817 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17818 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
17821 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
17822 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
17825 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
17826 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
17827 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
17830 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
17831 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
17832 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
17833 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
17834 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
17835 spelling checker on Unix.
17837 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
17841 search files for text that matches a regular expression
17844 count lines, words, characters
17847 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
17850 the stream editor, an advanced tool
17853 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
17856 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
17857 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
17858 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
17859 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
17865 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
17868 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
17869 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
17870 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
17873 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
17874 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
17877 Let someone else do the hard part.
17880 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
17881 appropriate tool, build one.
17884 As of this writing, all the programs discussed are available from
17885 @uref{http://ftp.gnu.org/old-gnu/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz},
17886 with more recent versions available from
17887 @uref{http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/coreutils}.
17889 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
17890 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
17891 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
17892 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
17893 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
17894 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
17895 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
17896 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
17897 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
17900 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
17901 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
17902 still in print and are well worth
17903 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
17904 how I view programming.
17906 The programs in both books are available from
17907 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
17908 For a number of years, there was an active
17909 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
17910 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
17911 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
17912 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
17914 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
17915 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
17916 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
17917 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
17918 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
17920 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
17921 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
17923 @node GNU Free Documentation License
17924 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
17928 @node Concept index
17935 @c Local variables:
17936 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32